84643b549beadd1d230ee9d3c0620d75a0aedc4d
[gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2 @c 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
4 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
5
6 @node Target Macros
7 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
8 @cindex machine description macros
9 @cindex target description macros
10 @cindex macros, target description
11 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
12
13 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
14 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
15 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
16 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
17 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
18 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
19 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
20 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
21 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
22 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
23 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
24 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
25 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
26
27 @menu
28 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
29 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
30 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
31 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
32 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
33 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
34 * Escape Sequences:: Defining the value of target character escape sequences
35 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
38 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
39 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
40 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
41 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
42 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
43 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
44 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
45 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
46 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
47 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
48 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
49 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
50 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
51 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
52 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
53 * Misc:: Everything else.
54 @end menu
55
56 @node Target Structure
57 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
58 @cindex target hooks
59 @cindex target functions
60
61 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
62 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
63 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
64 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
65 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
66 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
67 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
68 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
69 @smallexample
70 #include "target.h"
71 #include "target-def.h"
72
73 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
74
75 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
76 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
77
78 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
79 @end smallexample
80 @end deftypevar
81
82 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
83 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
84 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
85 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
86 @code{targetm} structure.
87
88 @node Driver
89 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
90 @cindex driver
91 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
92
93 @c prevent bad page break with this line
94 You can control the compilation driver.
95
96 @table @code
97 @findex SWITCH_TAKES_ARG
98 @item SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{char})
99 A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
100 takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
101 option takes--zero, for many options.
102
103 By default, this macro is defined as
104 @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
105 properly. You need not define @code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
106 wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
107 should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
108 additional options.
109
110 @findex WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG
111 @item WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{name})
112 A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{name}}
113 takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
114 option takes--zero, for many options. This macro rather than
115 @code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} is used for multi-character option names.
116
117 By default, this macro is defined as
118 @code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
119 properly. You need not define @code{WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
120 wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
121 should call @code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
122 additional options.
123
124 @findex SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION
125 @item SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION (@var{char})
126 A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
127 stops compilation before the generation of an executable. The value is
128 boolean, nonzero if the option does stop an executable from being
129 generated, zero otherwise.
130
131 By default, this macro is defined as
132 @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION}, which handles the standard
133 options properly. You need not define
134 @code{SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} unless you wish to add additional
135 options which affect the generation of an executable. Any redefinition
136 should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} and then check
137 for additional options.
138
139 @findex SWITCHES_NEED_SPACES
140 @item SWITCHES_NEED_SPACES
141 A string-valued C expression which enumerates the options for which
142 the linker needs a space between the option and its argument.
143
144 If this macro is not defined, the default value is @code{""}.
145
146 @findex TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE
147 @item TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE
148 If defined, a list of pairs of strings, the first of which is a
149 potential command line target to the @file{gcc} driver program, and the
150 second of which is a space-separated (tabs and other whitespace are not
151 supported) list of options with which to replace the first option. The
152 target defining this list is responsible for assuring that the results
153 are valid. Replacement options may not be the @code{--opt} style, they
154 must be the @code{-opt} style. It is the intention of this macro to
155 provide a mechanism for substitution that affects the multilibs chosen,
156 such as one option that enables many options, some of which select
157 multilibs. Example nonsensical definition, where @code{-malt-abi},
158 @code{-EB}, and @code{-mspoo} cause different multilibs to be chosen:
159
160 @smallexample
161 #define TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE \
162 @{ "-fast", "-march=fast-foo -malt-abi -I/usr/fast-foo" @}, \
163 @{ "-compat", "-EB -malign=4 -mspoo" @}
164 @end smallexample
165
166 @findex DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
167 @item DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
168 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
169 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
170
171 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
172 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
173 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
174 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
175 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
176 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
177
178 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
179 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
180 that the other specs are easier to write.
181
182 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
183
184 @findex CPP_SPEC
185 @item CPP_SPEC
186 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
187 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
188 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
189
190 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
191
192 @findex CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
193 @item CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
194 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
195 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
196 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
197
198 @findex CC1_SPEC
199 @item CC1_SPEC
200 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
201 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
202 front ends.
203 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
204 for GCC to pass to front ends.
205
206 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
207
208 @findex CC1PLUS_SPEC
209 @item CC1PLUS_SPEC
210 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
211 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
212 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
213
214 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
215 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
216 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
217 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
218
219 @findex ASM_SPEC
220 @item ASM_SPEC
221 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
222 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
223 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
224 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
225
226 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
227
228 @findex ASM_FINAL_SPEC
229 @item ASM_FINAL_SPEC
230 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
231 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
232 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
233 an example of this.
234
235 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
236
237 @findex AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
238 @item AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
239 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
240 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
241 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
242 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
243 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
244
245 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
246 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
247 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
248 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
249
250 @findex LINK_SPEC
251 @item LINK_SPEC
252 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
253 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
254 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
255
256 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
257
258 @findex LIB_SPEC
259 @item LIB_SPEC
260 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
261 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
262 command given to the linker.
263
264 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
265 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
266
267 @findex LIBGCC_SPEC
268 @item LIBGCC_SPEC
269 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
270 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
271 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
272 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
273
274 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
275 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
276
277 @findex STARTFILE_SPEC
278 @item STARTFILE_SPEC
279 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
280 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
281 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
282
283 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
284 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
285
286 @findex ENDFILE_SPEC
287 @item ENDFILE_SPEC
288 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
289 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
290 the very end of the command given to the linker.
291
292 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
293
294 @findex THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
295 @item THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
296 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
297 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
298 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
299 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
300 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
301 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
302 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
303
304 @findex EXTRA_SPECS
305 @item EXTRA_SPECS
306 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
307 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
308 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
309
310 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
311 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
312 string constant that provides the specification.
313
314 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
315
316 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
317 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
318 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
319 these definitions.
320
321 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
322 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
323 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
324 used.
325
326 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
327
328 @example
329 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
330 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
331
332 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
333 @end example
334
335 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
336 @smallexample
337 #undef CPP_SPEC
338 #define CPP_SPEC \
339 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
340 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
341 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
342 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
343
344 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
345 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
346 @end smallexample
347
348 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
349 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
350
351 @smallexample
352 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
353 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
354 @end smallexample
355
356 @findex LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL
357 @item LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL
358 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
359 @file{libgcc.a} itself and should not pass @option{-L} options to the
360 linker. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
361 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search and will
362 pass @option{-L} options to it.
363
364 @findex LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
365 @item LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
366 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
367 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
368 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
369 This macro is similar to @code{LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL}, except that it does
370 not affect @option{-L} options.
371
372 @findex LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
373 @item LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
374 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
375 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
376
377 @findex LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
378 @item LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
379 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
380 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
381 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
382 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
383 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
384 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
385 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
386
387 @findex LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
388 @item LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
389 A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
390 directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
391 removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
392
393 @findex MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
394 @item MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
395 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
396 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
397 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
398 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
399
400 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
401 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
402 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
403 @xref{Target Fragment}.
404
405 @findex RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
406 @item RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
407 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
408 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
409 indicates an absolute file name.
410
411 @findex STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX
412 @item STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX
413 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
414 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/lib/gcc-lib/} as the default prefix to
415 try when searching for the executable files of the compiler.
416
417 @findex MD_EXEC_PREFIX
418 @item MD_EXEC_PREFIX
419 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
420 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
421 when the @option{-b} option is used, or the compiler is built as a cross
422 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
423 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
424
425 @findex STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
426 @item STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
427 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
428 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/lib/} as the default prefix to
429 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
430
431 @findex MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
432 @item MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
433 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
434 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
435 @option{-b} option is used, or when the compiler is built as a cross
436 compiler.
437
438 @findex MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
439 @item MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
440 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
441 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the @option{-b} option is
442 used, or when the compiler is built as a cross compiler.
443
444 @findex INIT_ENVIRONMENT
445 @item INIT_ENVIRONMENT
446 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
447 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
448 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
449 initialize the necessary environment variables.
450
451 @findex LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
452 @item LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
453 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
454 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
455 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
456 comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
457
458 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
459 replacement.
460
461 @findex MODIFY_TARGET_NAME
462 @item MODIFY_TARGET_NAME
463 Define this macro if you with to define command-line switches that modify the
464 default target name
465
466 For each switch, you can include a string to be appended to the first
467 part of the configuration name or a string to be deleted from the
468 configuration name, if present. The definition should be an initializer
469 for an array of structures. Each array element should have three
470 elements: the switch name (a string constant, including the initial
471 dash), one of the enumeration codes @code{ADD} or @code{DELETE} to
472 indicate whether the string should be inserted or deleted, and the string
473 to be inserted or deleted (a string constant).
474
475 For example, on a machine where @samp{64} at the end of the
476 configuration name denotes a 64-bit target and you want the @option{-32}
477 and @option{-64} switches to select between 32- and 64-bit targets, you would
478 code
479
480 @smallexample
481 #define MODIFY_TARGET_NAME \
482 @{ @{ "-32", DELETE, "64"@}, \
483 @{"-64", ADD, "64"@}@}
484 @end smallexample
485
486
487 @findex SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
488 @item SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
489 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
490 system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
491 directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
492 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
493
494 Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
495 specified.
496
497 @findex STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
498 @item STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
499 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
500 standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
501 try when searching for header files.
502
503 Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search either
504 @file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
505
506 @findex STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
507 @item STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
508 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
509 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
510 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
511
512 @findex INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
513 @item INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
514 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
515 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
516 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
517 @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
518 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
519 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
520 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
521 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
522
523 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
524 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
525 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
526 for C++-only directories,
527 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
528 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
529 the array with a null element.
530
531 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
532 if any, in all upper-case letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
533 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
534 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
535
536 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
537
538 @example
539 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
540 @{ \
541 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
542 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
543 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
544 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
545 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
546 @}
547 @end example
548 @end table
549
550 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
551
552 @enumerate
553 @item
554 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
555
556 @item
557 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
558
559 @item
560 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
561
562 @item
563 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.
564
565 @item
566 @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}.
567
568 @item
569 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
570 @end enumerate
571
572 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
573
574 @enumerate
575 @item
576 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
577
578 @item
579 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
580
581 @item
582 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
583 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
584
585 @item
586 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.
587
588 @item
589 @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}.
590
591 @item
592 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
593
594 @item
595 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if any.
596
597 @item
598 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}.
599
600 @item
601 @file{/lib/}.
602
603 @item
604 @file{/usr/lib/}.
605 @end enumerate
606
607 @node Run-time Target
608 @section Run-time Target Specification
609 @cindex run-time target specification
610 @cindex predefined macros
611 @cindex target specifications
612
613 @c prevent bad page break with this line
614 Here are run-time target specifications.
615
616 @table @code
617 @findex TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS
618 @item TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS()
619 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
620 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target cpu, using
621 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
622 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
623 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
624 finished command line option processing your code can use those
625 results freely.
626
627 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
628 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
629 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
630 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
631
632 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
633 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
634 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
635 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
636 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
637 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
638 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
639 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
640 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
641 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
642
643 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
644 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
645 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
646 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
647 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
648 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
649 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
650 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
651 preprocessing.
652
653 With @code{TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS} this macro obsoletes the
654 @code{CPP_PREDEFINES} target macro.
655
656 @findex TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS
657 @item TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS()
658 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
659 and is used for the target operating system instead.
660
661 With @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} this macro obsoletes the
662 @code{CPP_PREDEFINES} target macro.
663
664 @findex CPP_PREDEFINES
665 @item CPP_PREDEFINES
666 Define this to be a string constant containing @option{-D} options to
667 define the predefined macros that identify this machine and system.
668 These macros will be predefined unless the @option{-ansi} option (or a
669 @option{-std} option for strict ISO C conformance) is specified.
670
671 In addition, a parallel set of macros are predefined, whose names are
672 made by appending @samp{__} at the beginning and at the end. These
673 @samp{__} macros are permitted by the ISO standard, so they are
674 predefined regardless of whether @option{-ansi} or a @option{-std} option
675 is specified.
676
677 For example, on the Sun, one can use the following value:
678
679 @smallexample
680 "-Dmc68000 -Dsun -Dunix"
681 @end smallexample
682
683 The result is to define the macros @code{__mc68000__}, @code{__sun__}
684 and @code{__unix__} unconditionally, and the macros @code{mc68000},
685 @code{sun} and @code{unix} provided @option{-ansi} is not specified.
686
687 @findex extern int target_flags
688 @item extern int target_flags;
689 This declaration should be present.
690
691 @cindex optional hardware or system features
692 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
693 @item TARGET_@dots{}
694 This series of macros is to allow compiler command arguments to
695 enable or disable the use of optional features of the target machine.
696 For example, one machine description serves both the 68000 and
697 the 68020; a command argument tells the compiler whether it should
698 use 68020-only instructions or not. This command argument works
699 by means of a macro @code{TARGET_68020} that tests a bit in
700 @code{target_flags}.
701
702 Define a macro @code{TARGET_@var{featurename}} for each such option.
703 Its definition should test a bit in @code{target_flags}. It is
704 recommended that a helper macro @code{TARGET_MASK_@var{featurename}}
705 is defined for each bit-value to test, and used in
706 @code{TARGET_@var{featurename}} and @code{TARGET_SWITCHES}. For
707 example:
708
709 @smallexample
710 #define TARGET_MASK_68020 1
711 #define TARGET_68020 (target_flags & TARGET_MASK_68020)
712 @end smallexample
713
714 One place where these macros are used is in the condition-expressions
715 of instruction patterns. Note how @code{TARGET_68020} appears
716 frequently in the 68000 machine description file, @file{m68k.md}.
717 Another place they are used is in the definitions of the other
718 macros in the @file{@var{machine}.h} file.
719
720 @findex TARGET_SWITCHES
721 @item TARGET_SWITCHES
722 This macro defines names of command options to set and clear
723 bits in @code{target_flags}. Its definition is an initializer
724 with a subgrouping for each command option.
725
726 Each subgrouping contains a string constant, that defines the option
727 name, a number, which contains the bits to set in
728 @code{target_flags}, and a second string which is the description
729 displayed by @option{--help}. If the number is negative then the bits specified
730 by the number are cleared instead of being set. If the description
731 string is present but empty, then no help information will be displayed
732 for that option, but it will not count as an undocumented option. The
733 actual option name is made by appending @samp{-m} to the specified name.
734 Non-empty description strings should be marked with @code{N_(@dots{})} for
735 @command{xgettext}. Please do not mark empty strings because the empty
736 string is reserved by GNU gettext. @code{gettext("")} returns the header entry
737 of the message catalog with meta information, not the empty string.
738
739 In addition to the description for @option{--help},
740 more detailed documentation for each option should be added to
741 @file{invoke.texi}.
742
743 One of the subgroupings should have a null string. The number in
744 this grouping is the default value for @code{target_flags}. Any
745 target options act starting with that value.
746
747 Here is an example which defines @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}
748 with opposite meanings, and picks the latter as the default:
749
750 @smallexample
751 #define TARGET_SWITCHES \
752 @{ @{ "68020", TARGET_MASK_68020, "" @}, \
753 @{ "68000", -TARGET_MASK_68020, \
754 N_("Compile for the 68000") @}, \
755 @{ "", TARGET_MASK_68020, "" @}@}
756 @end smallexample
757
758 @findex TARGET_OPTIONS
759 @item TARGET_OPTIONS
760 This macro is similar to @code{TARGET_SWITCHES} but defines names of command
761 options that have values. Its definition is an initializer with a
762 subgrouping for each command option.
763
764 Each subgrouping contains a string constant, that defines the fixed part
765 of the option name, the address of a variable, and a description string.
766 Non-empty description strings should be marked with @code{N_(@dots{})} for
767 @command{xgettext}. Please do not mark empty strings because the empty
768 string is reserved by GNU gettext. @code{gettext("")} returns the header entry
769 of the message catalog with meta information, not the empty string.
770
771 The variable, type @code{char *}, is set to the variable part of the
772 given option if the fixed part matches. The actual option name is made
773 by appending @samp{-m} to the specified name. Again, each option should
774 also be documented in @file{invoke.texi}.
775
776 Here is an example which defines @option{-mshort-data-@var{number}}. If the
777 given option is @option{-mshort-data-512}, the variable @code{m88k_short_data}
778 will be set to the string @code{"512"}.
779
780 @smallexample
781 extern char *m88k_short_data;
782 #define TARGET_OPTIONS \
783 @{ @{ "short-data-", &m88k_short_data, \
784 N_("Specify the size of the short data section") @} @}
785 @end smallexample
786
787 @findex TARGET_VERSION
788 @item TARGET_VERSION
789 This macro is a C statement to print on @code{stderr} a string
790 describing the particular machine description choice. Every machine
791 description should define @code{TARGET_VERSION}. For example:
792
793 @smallexample
794 #ifdef MOTOROLA
795 #define TARGET_VERSION \
796 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, Motorola syntax)");
797 #else
798 #define TARGET_VERSION \
799 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, MIT syntax)");
800 #endif
801 @end smallexample
802
803 @findex OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
804 @item OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
805 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
806 a particular target machine. You can define a macro
807 @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS} to take account of this. This macro, if
808 defined, is executed once just after all the command options have been
809 parsed.
810
811 Don't use this macro to turn on various extra optimizations for
812 @option{-O}. That is what @code{OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS} is for.
813
814 @findex OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS
815 @item OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS (@var{level}, @var{size})
816 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
817 various optimization levels. This macro, if defined, is executed once
818 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
819 of the command options have been parsed. Values set in this macro are
820 used as the default values for the other command line options.
821
822 @var{level} is the optimization level specified; 2 if @option{-O2} is
823 specified, 1 if @option{-O} is specified, and 0 if neither is specified.
824
825 @var{size} is nonzero if @option{-Os} is specified and zero otherwise.
826
827 You should not use this macro to change options that are not
828 machine-specific. These should uniformly selected by the same
829 optimization level on all supported machines. Use this macro to enable
830 machine-specific optimizations.
831
832 @strong{Do not examine @code{write_symbols} in
833 this macro!} The debugging options are not supposed to alter the
834 generated code.
835
836 @findex CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
837 @item CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
838 Define this macro if debugging can be performed even without a frame
839 pointer. If this macro is defined, GCC will turn on the
840 @option{-fomit-frame-pointer} option whenever @option{-O} is specified.
841 @end table
842
843 @node Per-Function Data
844 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
845 @cindex per-function data
846 @cindex data structures
847
848 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
849 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
850 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
851 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
852 when another one comes along.
853
854 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
855 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
856 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
857 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
858 to their own specific data.
859
860 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
861 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
862 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
863 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
864
865 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
866 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
867 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
868 function, for level 0.
869
870 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
871 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
872 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
873 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
874 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
875 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
876 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
877 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
878 longer supported.
879
880 The macro and function pointers are described below.
881
882 @table @code
883 @findex INIT_EXPANDERS
884 @item INIT_EXPANDERS
885 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
886 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
887 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
888 function pointers below.
889
890 @findex init_machine_status
891 @item init_machine_status
892 This is a @code{void (*)(struct function *)} function pointer. If this
893 pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per function, before function
894 compilation starts, in order to allow the target to perform any target
895 specific initialization of the @code{struct function} structure. It is
896 intended that this would be used to initialize the @code{machine} of
897 that structure.
898
899 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC.
900 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
901 @code{ggc_alloc}, including the structure itself.
902
903 @end table
904
905 @node Storage Layout
906 @section Storage Layout
907 @cindex storage layout
908
909 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
910 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
911 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
912 @xref{Run-time Target}.
913
914 @table @code
915 @findex BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
916 @item BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
917 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
918 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
919 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
920 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
921 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
922 macro need not be a constant.
923
924 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
925 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
926
927 @findex BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
928 @item BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
929 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
930 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
931
932 @findex WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
933 @item WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
934 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
935 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
936 memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
937 order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers. This
938 macro need not be a constant.
939
940 @findex LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
941 @item LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
942 Define this macro if @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} is not constant. This must be a
943 constant value with the same meaning as @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN}, which will be
944 used only when compiling @file{libgcc2.c}. Typically the value will be set
945 based on preprocessor defines.
946
947 @findex FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
948 @item FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
949 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
950 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
951 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
952 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
953
954 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
955 multi-word integers.
956
957 @findex BITS_PER_UNIT
958 @item BITS_PER_UNIT
959 Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
960 unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
961
962 @findex BITS_PER_WORD
963 @item BITS_PER_WORD
964 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
965 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
966
967 @findex MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
968 @item MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
969 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
970 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
971 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
972
973 @findex UNITS_PER_WORD
974 @item UNITS_PER_WORD
975 Number of storage units in a word; normally 4.
976
977 @findex MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
978 @item MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
979 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
980 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
981 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
982
983 @findex POINTER_SIZE
984 @item POINTER_SIZE
985 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
986 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
987 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
988 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
989
990 @findex POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
991 @item POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
992 A C expression whose value is greater than zero if pointers that need to be
993 extended from being @code{POINTER_SIZE} bits wide to @code{Pmode} are to
994 be zero-extended and zero if they are to be sign-extended. If the value
995 is less then zero then there must be an "ptr_extend" instruction that
996 extends a pointer from @code{POINTER_SIZE} to @code{Pmode}.
997
998 You need not define this macro if the @code{POINTER_SIZE} is equal
999 to the width of @code{Pmode}.
1000
1001 @findex PROMOTE_MODE
1002 @item PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
1003 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
1004 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
1005 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
1006 scalar type.
1007
1008 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
1009 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
1010 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
1011 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
1012 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
1013 counterparts.
1014
1015 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
1016 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
1017 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
1018 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
1019 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
1020 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
1021
1022 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
1023
1024 @findex PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS
1025 @item PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS
1026 Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
1027 should also be done for outgoing function arguments.
1028
1029 @findex PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN
1030 @item PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN
1031 Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
1032 should also be done for the return value of functions.
1033
1034 If this macro is defined, @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same
1035 promotions done by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
1036
1037 @findex PROMOTE_FOR_CALL_ONLY
1038 @item PROMOTE_FOR_CALL_ONLY
1039 Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
1040 should @emph{only} be performed for outgoing function arguments or
1041 function return values, as specified by @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS}
1042 and @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN}, respectively.
1043
1044 @findex PARM_BOUNDARY
1045 @item PARM_BOUNDARY
1046 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
1047 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
1048 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
1049 size of an integer.
1050
1051 @findex STACK_BOUNDARY
1052 @item STACK_BOUNDARY
1053 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
1054 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
1055 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
1056 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
1057 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
1058
1059 @findex PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1060 @item PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1061 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
1062 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
1063 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
1064 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
1065 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1066
1067 @findex FORCE_PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY_IN_MAIN
1068 @item FORCE_PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY_IN_MAIN
1069 A C expression that evaluates true if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is
1070 not guaranteed by the runtime and we should emit code to align the stack
1071 at the beginning of @code{main}.
1072
1073 @cindex @code{PUSH_ROUNDING}, interaction with @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}
1074 If @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} is not defined, the stack will always be aligned
1075 to the specified boundary. If @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} is defined and specifies
1076 a less strict alignment than @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, the stack may
1077 be momentarily unaligned while pushing arguments.
1078
1079 @findex FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1080 @item FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1081 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1082
1083 @findex BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1084 @item BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1085 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in bits.
1086
1087 @findex MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1088 @item MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1089 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1090 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1091 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1092 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1093
1094 @findex BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1095 @item BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1096 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1097 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1098 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1099 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1100
1101 @findex ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN
1102 @item ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1103 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1104 alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1105 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1106 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1107 field alignment has not been set by the
1108 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1109
1110 @findex MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1111 @item MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1112 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1113 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1114 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1115 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1116
1117 @findex DATA_ALIGNMENT
1118 @item DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1119 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1120 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1121 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1122 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1123
1124 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1125
1126 @findex strcpy
1127 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1128 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1129 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1130 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1131
1132 @findex CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT
1133 @item CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1134 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1135 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1136 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1137 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1138 align the object.
1139
1140 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1141
1142 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1143 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1144 constants can be done inline.
1145
1146 @findex LOCAL_ALIGNMENT
1147 @item LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1148 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1149 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1150 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1151 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1152
1153 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1154
1155 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1156 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1157
1158 @findex EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1159 @item EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1160 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1161 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1162
1163 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1164
1165 @findex STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1166 @item STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1167 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1168 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1169
1170 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1171 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1172
1173 @findex STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1174 @item STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1175 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1176 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1177 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1178
1179 @findex PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1180 @item PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1181 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1182 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1183
1184 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1185 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1186 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1187 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1188 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1189
1190 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1191 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1192 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1193 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1194
1195 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1196 structure.
1197
1198 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1199 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1200
1201 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1202 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1203 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1204 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1205
1206 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1207 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1208 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1209
1210 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1211 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1212 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1213
1214 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1215 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1216 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1217
1218 @example
1219 struct foo1
1220 @{
1221 char x;
1222 char :0;
1223 char y;
1224 @};
1225
1226 struct foo2
1227 @{
1228 char x;
1229 int :0;
1230 char y;
1231 @};
1232
1233 main ()
1234 @{
1235 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1236 sizeof (struct foo1));
1237 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1238 sizeof (struct foo2));
1239 exit (0);
1240 @}
1241 @end example
1242
1243 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1244 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1245
1246 @findex BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1247 @item BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1248 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1249 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1250
1251 @findex MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK
1252 @item MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1253 Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1254 @code{BLKMODE}.
1255
1256 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1257 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1258 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1259 retain the field's mode.
1260
1261 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{c4x.h} for an example
1262 of how to use this macro to prevent a structure having a floating point
1263 field from being accessed in an integer mode.
1264
1265 @findex ROUND_TYPE_SIZE
1266 @item ROUND_TYPE_SIZE (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1267 Define this macro as an expression for the overall size of a type
1268 (given by @var{type} as a tree node) when the size computed in the
1269 usual way is @var{computed} and the alignment is @var{specified}.
1270
1271 The default is to round @var{computed} up to a multiple of @var{specified}.
1272
1273 @findex ROUND_TYPE_SIZE_UNIT
1274 @item ROUND_TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1275 Similar to @code{ROUND_TYPE_SIZE}, but sizes and alignments are
1276 specified in units (bytes). If you define @code{ROUND_TYPE_SIZE},
1277 you must also define this macro and they must be defined consistently
1278 with each other.
1279
1280 @findex ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN
1281 @item ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1282 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1283 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1284 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1285 @var{specified}.
1286
1287 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1288 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1289
1290 @findex MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1291 @item MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1292 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1293 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1294 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1295 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1296 (DImode)} is assumed.
1297
1298 @findex VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
1299 @item VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P(@var{mode})
1300 Define this macro to be nonzero if the port is prepared to handle insns
1301 involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it must have move
1302 patterns for this mode.
1303
1304 @findex STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE
1305 @item STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1306 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1307 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1308 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1309 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1310 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1311 having its mode specified.
1312
1313 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1314 would most commonly define this macro if the
1315 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1316 64-bit mode.
1317
1318 @findex STACK_SIZE_MODE
1319 @item STACK_SIZE_MODE
1320 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1321 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1322 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1323
1324 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1325 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1326 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1327
1328 @findex TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT
1329 @item TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT
1330 A code distinguishing the floating point format of the target machine.
1331 There are five defined values:
1332
1333 @table @code
1334 @findex IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
1335 @item IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
1336 This code indicates IEEE floating point. It is the default; there is no
1337 need to define this macro when the format is IEEE@.
1338
1339 @findex VAX_FLOAT_FORMAT
1340 @item VAX_FLOAT_FORMAT
1341 This code indicates the ``F float'' (for @code{float}) and ``D float''
1342 or ``G float'' formats (for @code{double}) used on the VAX and PDP-11@.
1343
1344 @findex IBM_FLOAT_FORMAT
1345 @item IBM_FLOAT_FORMAT
1346 This code indicates the format used on the IBM System/370.
1347
1348 @findex C4X_FLOAT_FORMAT
1349 @item C4X_FLOAT_FORMAT
1350 This code indicates the format used on the TMS320C3x/C4x.
1351
1352 @findex UNKNOWN_FLOAT_FORMAT
1353 @item UNKNOWN_FLOAT_FORMAT
1354 This code indicates any other format.
1355 @end table
1356
1357 If any other
1358 formats are actually in use on supported machines, new codes should be
1359 defined for them.
1360
1361 The ordering of the component words of floating point values stored in
1362 memory is controlled by @code{FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN}.
1363
1364 @findex MODE_HAS_NANS
1365 @item MODE_HAS_NANS (@var{mode})
1366 When defined, this macro should be true if @var{mode} has a NaN
1367 representation. The compiler assumes that NaNs are not equal to
1368 anything (including themselves) and that addition, subtraction,
1369 multiplication and division all return NaNs when one operand is
1370 NaN@.
1371
1372 By default, this macro is true if @var{mode} is a floating-point
1373 mode and the target floating-point format is IEEE@.
1374
1375 @findex MODE_HAS_INFINITIES
1376 @item MODE_HAS_INFINITIES (@var{mode})
1377 This macro should be true if @var{mode} can represent infinity. At
1378 present, the compiler uses this macro to decide whether @samp{x - x}
1379 is always defined. By default, the macro is true when @var{mode}
1380 is a floating-point mode and the target format is IEEE@.
1381
1382 @findex MODE_HAS_SIGNED_ZEROS
1383 @item MODE_HAS_SIGNED_ZEROS (@var{mode})
1384 True if @var{mode} distinguishes between positive and negative zero.
1385 The rules are expected to follow the IEEE standard:
1386
1387 @itemize @bullet
1388 @item
1389 @samp{x + x} has the same sign as @samp{x}.
1390
1391 @item
1392 If the sum of two values with opposite sign is zero, the result is
1393 positive for all rounding modes expect towards @minus{}infinity, for
1394 which it is negative.
1395
1396 @item
1397 The sign of a product or quotient is negative when exactly one
1398 of the operands is negative.
1399 @end itemize
1400
1401 The default definition is true if @var{mode} is a floating-point
1402 mode and the target format is IEEE@.
1403
1404 @findex MODE_HAS_SIGN_DEPENDENT_ROUNDING
1405 @item MODE_HAS_SIGN_DEPENDENT_ROUNDING (@var{mode})
1406 If defined, this macro should be true for @var{mode} if it has at
1407 least one rounding mode in which @samp{x} and @samp{-x} can be
1408 rounded to numbers of different magnitude. Two such modes are
1409 towards @minus{}infinity and towards +infinity.
1410
1411 The default definition of this macro is true if @var{mode} is
1412 a floating-point mode and the target format is IEEE@.
1413
1414 @findex ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1415 @item ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1416 If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1417 mode is towards zero. A true value has the following effects:
1418
1419 @itemize @bullet
1420 @item
1421 @code{MODE_HAS_SIGN_DEPENDENT_ROUNDING} will be false for all modes.
1422
1423 @item
1424 @file{libgcc.a}'s floating-point emulator will round towards zero
1425 rather than towards nearest.
1426
1427 @item
1428 The compiler's floating-point emulator will round towards zero after
1429 doing arithmetic, and when converting from the internal float format to
1430 the target format.
1431 @end itemize
1432
1433 The macro does not affect the parsing of string literals. When the
1434 primary rounding mode is towards zero, library functions like
1435 @code{strtod} might still round towards nearest, and the compiler's
1436 parser should behave like the target's @code{strtod} where possible.
1437
1438 Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1439
1440 @findex LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL
1441 @item LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1442 This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1443 bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1444 exponent for normal numbers instead.
1445
1446 Defining this macro to true for @var{size} causes @code{MODE_HAS_NANS}
1447 and @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES} to be false for @var{size}-bit modes.
1448 It also affects the way @file{libgcc.a} and @file{real.c} emulate
1449 floating-point arithmetic.
1450
1451 The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1452 @end table
1453
1454 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_OPAQUE_P (tree @var{type})
1455 This target hook should return @code{true} a vector is opaque. That
1456 is, if no cast is needed when copying a vector value of type
1457 @var{type} into another vector lvalue of the same size. Vector opaque
1458 types cannot be initialized. The default is that there are no such
1459 types.
1460 @end deftypefn
1461
1462 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (tree @var{record_type})
1463 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1464 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1465 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1466 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1467 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1468 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1469 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1470 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1471 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1472 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1473 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1474
1475 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1476 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1477 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1478 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1479 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1480 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1481 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1482
1483 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1484 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1485 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1486 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1487 may affect its placement.
1488 @end deftypefn
1489
1490 @node Type Layout
1491 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1492
1493 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1494 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1495 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1496 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1497
1498 @table @code
1499 @findex INT_TYPE_SIZE
1500 @item INT_TYPE_SIZE
1501 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1502 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1503
1504 @findex SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1505 @item SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1506 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1507 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1508 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1509 unit.)
1510
1511 @findex LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1512 @item LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1513 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1514 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1515
1516 @findex ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1517 @item ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1518 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1519 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C. In
1520 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1521 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1522 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1523
1524 @findex MAX_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1525 @item MAX_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1526 Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1527 target machine. If this is undefined, the default is
1528 @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
1529 largest value that @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time. This is
1530 used in @code{cpp}.
1531
1532 @findex LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1533 @item LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1534 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1535 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1536 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1537 macro must be at least 64.
1538
1539 @findex CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1540 @item CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1541 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1542 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1543 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1544
1545 @findex BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1546 @item BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1547 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1548 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1549 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1550
1551 @findex FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1552 @item FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1553 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1554 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1555
1556 @findex DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1557 @item DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1558 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1559 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1560 words.
1561
1562 @findex LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1563 @item LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1564 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1565 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1566 words.
1567
1568 @findex MAX_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1569 Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on the
1570 target machine. If this is undefined, the default is
1571 @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is
1572 the largest value that @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time.
1573 This is used in @code{cpp}.
1574
1575 @findex TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1576 @item TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1577 A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1578 assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1579 default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1580 @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1581
1582 @findex WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1583 @item WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1584 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1585 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1586 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1587 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1588 is the default.
1589
1590 @findex DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1591 @item DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1592 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1593 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1594 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1595 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1596
1597 @findex DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1598 @item DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1599 A C expression to determine whether to give an @code{enum} type
1600 only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range of possible values
1601 of that type. A nonzero value means to do that; a zero value means all
1602 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1603
1604 If you don't define the macro, the default is 0.
1605
1606 @findex SIZE_TYPE
1607 @item SIZE_TYPE
1608 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1609 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1610 contents of the string.
1611
1612 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1613 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1614 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1615 of the data type names defined in the function
1616 @code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1617 omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1618 crash on startup.
1619
1620 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1621 int"}.
1622
1623 @findex PTRDIFF_TYPE
1624 @item PTRDIFF_TYPE
1625 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1626 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1627 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1628 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1629
1630 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1631
1632 @findex WCHAR_TYPE
1633 @item WCHAR_TYPE
1634 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1635 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1636 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1637 information.
1638
1639 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1640
1641 @findex WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1642 @item WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1643 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1644 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1645 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1646
1647 @findex MAX_WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1648 @item MAX_WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1649 Maximum number for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1650 characters. If this is undefined, the default is
1651 @code{WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
1652 largest value that @code{WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time. This is
1653 used in @code{cpp}.
1654
1655 @findex GCOV_TYPE_SIZE
1656 @item GCOV_TYPE_SIZE
1657 A C expression for the size in bits of the type used for gcov counters on the
1658 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one
1659 @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE} in case it is greater or equal to 64-bit and
1660 @code{LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE} otherwise. You may want to re-define the type to
1661 ensure atomicity for counters in multithreaded programs.
1662
1663 @findex WINT_TYPE
1664 @item WINT_TYPE
1665 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1666 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1667 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1668 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1669 information.
1670
1671 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1672
1673 @findex INTMAX_TYPE
1674 @item INTMAX_TYPE
1675 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1676 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1677 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1678 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1679
1680 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1681 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1682 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1683
1684 @findex UINTMAX_TYPE
1685 @item UINTMAX_TYPE
1686 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1687 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1688 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1689 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1690
1691 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1692 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1693 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1694 int}.
1695
1696 @findex TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1697 @item TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1698 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1699 that looks like:
1700
1701 @example
1702 struct @{
1703 union @{
1704 void (*fn)();
1705 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1706 @};
1707 ptrdiff_t delta;
1708 @};
1709 @end example
1710
1711 @noindent
1712 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1713 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1714 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1715 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1716 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1717 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1718 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1719 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1720
1721 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1722 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1723 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1724 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1725 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1726 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1727 architecture, you should define this macro to
1728 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1729
1730 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1731 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1732 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1733 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1734
1735 @findex TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1736 @item TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1737 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1738 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1739 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1740 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1741 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1742 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1743
1744 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1745 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1746
1747 @findex TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1748 @item TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1749 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1750 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1751 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1752 when special alignment is necessary. */
1753
1754 @findex TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1755 @item TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1756 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1757 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1758 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1759 of words in each data entry.
1760 @end table
1761
1762 @node Escape Sequences
1763 @section Target Character Escape Sequences
1764 @cindex escape sequences
1765
1766 By default, GCC assumes that the C character escape sequences take on
1767 their ASCII values for the target. If this is not correct, you must
1768 explicitly define all of the macros below.
1769
1770 @table @code
1771 @findex TARGET_BELL
1772 @item TARGET_BELL
1773 A C constant expression for the integer value for escape sequence
1774 @samp{\a}.
1775
1776 @findex TARGET_ESC
1777 @item TARGET_ESC
1778 A C constant expression for the integer value of the target escape
1779 character. As an extension, GCC evaluates the escape sequences
1780 @samp{\e} and @samp{\E} to this.
1781
1782 @findex TARGET_TAB
1783 @findex TARGET_BS
1784 @findex TARGET_NEWLINE
1785 @item TARGET_BS
1786 @itemx TARGET_TAB
1787 @itemx TARGET_NEWLINE
1788 C constant expressions for the integer values for escape sequences
1789 @samp{\b}, @samp{\t} and @samp{\n}.
1790
1791 @findex TARGET_VT
1792 @findex TARGET_FF
1793 @findex TARGET_CR
1794 @item TARGET_VT
1795 @itemx TARGET_FF
1796 @itemx TARGET_CR
1797 C constant expressions for the integer values for escape sequences
1798 @samp{\v}, @samp{\f} and @samp{\r}.
1799 @end table
1800
1801 @node Registers
1802 @section Register Usage
1803 @cindex register usage
1804
1805 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1806 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1807
1808 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1809 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1810 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1811 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1812 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1813
1814 @menu
1815 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1816 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1817 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1818 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1819 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1820 @end menu
1821
1822 @node Register Basics
1823 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1824
1825 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1826 Registers have various characteristics.
1827
1828 @table @code
1829 @findex FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1830 @item FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1831 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1832 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1833 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1834 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1835
1836 @item FIXED_REGISTERS
1837 @findex FIXED_REGISTERS
1838 @cindex fixed register
1839 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1840 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1841 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1842 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1843 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1844 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1845 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1846
1847 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1848 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1849 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1850
1851 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1852 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1853 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1854 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1855 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1856
1857 @findex CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1858 @item CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1859 @cindex call-used register
1860 @cindex call-clobbered register
1861 @cindex call-saved register
1862 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1863 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1864 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1865 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1866 function calls.
1867
1868 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1869 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1870 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1871
1872 @findex CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1873 @item CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1874 @cindex call-used register
1875 @cindex call-clobbered register
1876 @cindex call-saved register
1877 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1878 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1879 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1880 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1881 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1882
1883 @findex HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED
1884 @item HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1885 @cindex call-used register
1886 @cindex call-clobbered register
1887 @cindex call-saved register
1888 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1889 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1890 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1891 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1892 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1893
1894 @findex CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1895 @findex fixed_regs
1896 @findex call_used_regs
1897 @item CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1898 Zero or more C statements that may conditionally modify five variables
1899 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1900 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1901 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1902 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1903 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1904 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1905 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1906 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1907 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1908 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1909 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1910 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1911 command options have been applied.
1912
1913 You need not define this macro if it has no work to do.
1914
1915 @cindex disabling certain registers
1916 @cindex controlling register usage
1917 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1918 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1919 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1920 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1921 the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1922 to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1923 is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1924
1925 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1926 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1927 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1928 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1929
1930 @findex NON_SAVING_SETJMP
1931 @item NON_SAVING_SETJMP
1932 If this macro is defined and has a nonzero value, it means that
1933 @code{setjmp} and related functions fail to save the registers, or that
1934 @code{longjmp} fails to restore them. To compensate, the compiler
1935 avoids putting variables in registers in functions that use
1936 @code{setjmp}.
1937
1938 @findex INCOMING_REGNO
1939 @item INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1940 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1941 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1942 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1943 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1944 outbound register.
1945
1946 @findex OUTGOING_REGNO
1947 @item OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1948 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1949 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1950 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1951 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1952 register.
1953
1954 @findex LOCAL_REGNO
1955 @item LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1956 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1957 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1958 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1959 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1960 gotos.
1961
1962 @ignore
1963 @findex PC_REGNUM
1964 @item PC_REGNUM
1965 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1966 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1967 @end ignore
1968 @end table
1969
1970 @node Allocation Order
1971 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1972 @cindex order of register allocation
1973 @cindex register allocation order
1974
1975 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1976 Registers are allocated in order.
1977
1978 @table @code
1979 @findex REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1980 @item REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1981 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1982 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1983 to use them (from most preferred to least).
1984
1985 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1986 (all else being equal).
1987
1988 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1989 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1990 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1991 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1992 the highest numbered allocable register first.
1993
1994 @findex ORDER_REGS_FOR_LOCAL_ALLOC
1995 @item ORDER_REGS_FOR_LOCAL_ALLOC
1996 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1997 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1998
1999 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2000 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2001 register; and so on.
2002
2003 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2004 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2005
2006 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2007 @end table
2008
2009 @node Values in Registers
2010 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2011
2012 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2013 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2014 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2015
2016 @table @code
2017 @findex HARD_REGNO_NREGS
2018 @item HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2019 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2020 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2021 @var{mode}.
2022
2023 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2024 definition of this macro is
2025
2026 @smallexample
2027 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2028 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2029 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2030 @end smallexample
2031
2032 @findex HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2033 @item HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2034 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2035 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2036 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2037 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2038
2039 @smallexample
2040 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2041 @end smallexample
2042
2043 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2044 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2045
2046 @cindex register pairs
2047 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2048 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2049 odd register numbers for such modes.
2050
2051 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2052 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2053 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2054 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2055
2056 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2057 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2058 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2059 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2060 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2061 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2062 to be tieable.
2063
2064 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2065 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2066 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2067 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2068 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2069 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2070
2071 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2072 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2073 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2074 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2075 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2076 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2077 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2078 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2079 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2080
2081 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2082 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2083 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2084 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2085 constraints for those instructions.
2086
2087 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2088 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2089 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2090 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2091 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2092
2093 @findex MODES_TIEABLE_P
2094 @item MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2095 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2096 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2097
2098 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2099 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2100 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2101 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2102 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2103 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2104
2105 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2106 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2107 allocation.
2108
2109 @findex AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2110 @item AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2111 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2112 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2113 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2114 @end table
2115
2116 @node Leaf Functions
2117 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2118
2119 @cindex leaf functions
2120 @cindex functions, leaf
2121 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2122 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2123 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2124 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2125 normally arrive.
2126
2127 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2128 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2129 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2130 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2131 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2132 functions''.
2133
2134 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2135 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2136 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2137 accomplish this.
2138
2139 @table @code
2140 @findex LEAF_REGISTERS
2141 @item LEAF_REGISTERS
2142 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2143 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2144 function treatment.
2145
2146 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2147 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2148 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2149 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2150 in this vector.
2151
2152 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2153 the treatment of leaf functions.
2154
2155 @findex LEAF_REG_REMAP
2156 @item LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2157 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2158 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2159
2160 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2161 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2162 will cause the compiler to abort.
2163
2164 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2165 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2166 this.
2167 @end table
2168
2169 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2170 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2171 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2172 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2173 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2174 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2175 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2176 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2177 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2178 functions which only use leaf registers.
2179 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after reload and is
2180 only useful if @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2181 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2182 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2183
2184 @node Stack Registers
2185 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2186
2187 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2188 ``registers'' form a stack, as in the 80387 coprocessor for the 80386.
2189 Stack registers are normally written by pushing onto the stack, and are
2190 numbered relative to the top of the stack.
2191
2192 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2193 they must be consecutively numbered.
2194
2195 @table @code
2196 @findex STACK_REGS
2197 @item STACK_REGS
2198 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2199
2200 @findex FIRST_STACK_REG
2201 @item FIRST_STACK_REG
2202 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2203 of the stack.
2204
2205 @findex LAST_STACK_REG
2206 @item LAST_STACK_REG
2207 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2208 the stack.
2209 @end table
2210
2211 @node Register Classes
2212 @section Register Classes
2213 @cindex register class definitions
2214 @cindex class definitions, register
2215
2216 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2217 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2218 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2219 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2220
2221 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2222 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2223 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2224
2225 @findex ALL_REGS
2226 @findex NO_REGS
2227 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2228 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2229 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2230 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2231
2232 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2233 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2234 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2235 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2236 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2237 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2238
2239 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2240 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2241
2242 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2243 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2244 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2245 them in operand constraints.
2246
2247 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2248 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2249 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2250 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2251 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code.
2252
2253 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2254 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2255 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2256 in their union.
2257
2258 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2259 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2260 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2261 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2262 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2263
2264 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2265 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2266 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2267 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2268 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2269 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2270 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2271 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2272 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2273
2274 @table @code
2275 @findex enum reg_class
2276 @item enum reg_class
2277 An enumeral type that must be defined with all the register class names
2278 as enumeral values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2279 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumeral value,
2280 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2281 tells how many classes there are.
2282
2283 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2284 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2285 in many of the tables described below.
2286
2287 @findex N_REG_CLASSES
2288 @item N_REG_CLASSES
2289 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2290
2291 @example
2292 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2293 @end example
2294
2295 @findex REG_CLASS_NAMES
2296 @item REG_CLASS_NAMES
2297 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2298 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2299
2300 @findex REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2301 @item REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2302 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2303 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2304 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2305 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2306
2307 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2308 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2309 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2310 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2311 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2312 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2313 so on.
2314
2315 @findex REGNO_REG_CLASS
2316 @item REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2317 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2318 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2319 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2320 register.
2321
2322 @findex BASE_REG_CLASS
2323 @item BASE_REG_CLASS
2324 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2325 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2326 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2327
2328 @findex MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS
2329 @item MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2330 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2331 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2332 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2333 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2334
2335 @findex INDEX_REG_CLASS
2336 @item INDEX_REG_CLASS
2337 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2338 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2339 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2340 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2341
2342 @findex CONSTRAINT_LEN
2343 @item CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2344 For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2345 @var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2346 constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2347 you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2348 constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2349 DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2350 to handle specially.
2351 There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2352 for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2353 transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2354 return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2355 will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2356
2357 @findex REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER
2358 @item REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2359 A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2360 letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2361 value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2362 the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2363 corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2364 to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2365
2366 @findex REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT
2367 @item REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2368 Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2369 passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2370 different variants.
2371
2372 @findex REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P
2373 @item REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2374 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2375 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses. It may be
2376 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2377 allocated such a hard register.
2378
2379 @findex REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P
2380 @item REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2381 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2382 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2383 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2384 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2385 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2386 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2387
2388 @findex REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P
2389 @item REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2390 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2391 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2392 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2393 allocated such a hard register.
2394
2395 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2396 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2397 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2398 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2399 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2400 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2401 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2402 only if neither labeling works.
2403
2404 @findex PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2405 @item PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2406 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2407 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2408 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2409 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2410 safe:
2411
2412 @example
2413 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2414 @end example
2415
2416 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2417 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2418 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2419 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2420 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2421
2422 If @var{x} is a @code{const_double}, by returning @code{NO_REGS}
2423 you can force @var{x} into a memory constant. This is useful on
2424 certain machines where immediate floating values cannot be loaded into
2425 certain kinds of registers.
2426
2427 @findex PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2428 @item PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2429 Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2430 input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2431 @var{class}, unchanged.
2432
2433 @findex LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS
2434 @item LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2435 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2436 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2437 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2438 ordinarily be used.
2439
2440 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2441 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2442
2443 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2444 smaller class.
2445
2446 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2447 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2448
2449 @findex SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS
2450 @findex SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2451 @findex SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2452 @item SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2453 @itemx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2454 @itemx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2455 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2456 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2457 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2458 from general registers, but not memory. Some machines allow copying all
2459 registers to and from memory, but require a scratch register for stores
2460 to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic address on the RT,
2461 and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC when compiling
2462 PIC)@. In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are
2463 required.
2464
2465 You should define these macros to indicate to the reload phase that it may
2466 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2467 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2468 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2469 you should define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2470 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2471 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2472
2473 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2474 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2475 should be defined to return the largest register class required. If the
2476 requirements for input and output reloads are the same, the macro
2477 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should be used instead of defining both
2478 macros identically.
2479
2480 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2481 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2482 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2483 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2484 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2485
2486 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2487 intermediate register), you should define patterns for
2488 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2489 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which will normally be
2490 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2491 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2492 register.
2493
2494 Define constraints for the reload register and scratch register that
2495 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2496 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2497 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2498 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2499 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2500
2501 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2502 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2503 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2504 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2505
2506 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2507 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2508 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2509 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2510 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2511 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2512 general registers.
2513
2514 @findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
2515 @item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2516 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2517 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2518 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2519 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2520 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2521 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2522
2523 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2524
2525 @findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX
2526 @item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2527 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2528 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2529 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2530 defined by this macro.
2531
2532 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2533 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2534
2535 @findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE
2536 @item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2537 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2538 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2539 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2540 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2541 same as that of @var{mode}.
2542
2543 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2544 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2545 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2546 registers.
2547
2548 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2549 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2550 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2551 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2552 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2553 details.
2554
2555 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2556 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2557 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2558
2559 @findex SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
2560 @item SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
2561 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
2562 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
2563 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
2564 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
2565 insn.
2566
2567 Define @code{SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES} to be an expression with a nonzero
2568 value on these machines. When this macro has a nonzero value, the
2569 compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of hard registers.
2570
2571 It is always safe to define this macro with a nonzero value, but if you
2572 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
2573 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this macro
2574 with a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out of
2575 spill registers and print a fatal error message. For most machines, you
2576 should not define this macro at all.
2577
2578 @findex CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2579 @item CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (@var{class})
2580 A C expression whose value is nonzero if pseudos that have been assigned
2581 to registers of class @var{class} would likely be spilled because
2582 registers of @var{class} are needed for spill registers.
2583
2584 The default value of this macro returns 1 if @var{class} has exactly one
2585 register and zero otherwise. On most machines, this default should be
2586 used. Only define this macro to some other expression if pseudos
2587 allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their hard
2588 registers were needed for spill registers. If this macro returns nonzero
2589 for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2590 @file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2591 register. If there would not be another register available for
2592 reallocation, you should not change the definition of this macro since
2593 the only effect of such a definition would be to slow down register
2594 allocation.
2595
2596 @findex CLASS_MAX_NREGS
2597 @item CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2598 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2599 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2600
2601 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2602 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2603 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2604 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2605
2606 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2607 in the reload pass.
2608
2609 @item CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2610 If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2611 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2612
2613 For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2614 floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2615 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2616 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2617 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2618 as below:
2619
2620 @example
2621 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2622 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2623 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2624 @end example
2625 @end table
2626
2627 Three other special macros describe which operands fit which constraint
2628 letters.
2629
2630 @table @code
2631 @findex CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P
2632 @item CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2633 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2634 letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2635 particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2636 letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2637 the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2638 not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2639 @var{value}.
2640
2641 @findex CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P
2642 @item CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2643 Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2644 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2645 between different variants.
2646
2647 @findex CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P
2648 @item CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2649 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2650 letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2651 (@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2652
2653 If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2654 @var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2655 range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2656 letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2657
2658 @code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2659 @code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2660 or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2661 between these kinds.
2662
2663 @findex CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P
2664 @item CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2665 Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2666 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2667 between different variants.
2668
2669 @findex EXTRA_CONSTRAINT
2670 @item EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2671 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2672 letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2673 memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2674 elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2675 @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2676 may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2677
2678 If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2679 if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2680 constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2681 constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2682
2683 For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2684 in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
2685 letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2686 @emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
2687 a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
2688 alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2689 does not include r0 on the output.
2690
2691 @findex EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR
2692 @item EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2693 Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2694 in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2695 variants.
2696
2697 @findex EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT
2698 @item EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2699 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2700 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
2701 be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
2702
2703 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2704 at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
2705 comprises a subset of all memory references including
2706 all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
2707 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2708 type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
2709
2710 For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
2711 memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
2712 register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
2713 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
2714 If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
2715 a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
2716 reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
2717 into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
2718 a @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
2719
2720 @findex EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT
2721 @item EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2722 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2723 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
2724 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
2725 be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
2726
2727 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2728 at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
2729 a subset of all memory addresses including
2730 all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
2731 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2732 type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
2733
2734 Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
2735 be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
2736 analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
2737 @end table
2738
2739 @node Stack and Calling
2740 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2741 @cindex calling conventions
2742
2743 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2744 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2745
2746 @menu
2747 * Frame Layout::
2748 * Exception Handling::
2749 * Stack Checking::
2750 * Frame Registers::
2751 * Elimination::
2752 * Stack Arguments::
2753 * Register Arguments::
2754 * Scalar Return::
2755 * Aggregate Return::
2756 * Caller Saves::
2757 * Function Entry::
2758 * Profiling::
2759 * Tail Calls::
2760 @end menu
2761
2762 @node Frame Layout
2763 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
2764 @cindex stack frame layout
2765 @cindex frame layout
2766
2767 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2768 Here is the basic stack layout.
2769
2770 @table @code
2771 @findex STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2772 @item STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2773 Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
2774 pointer to a smaller address.
2775
2776 When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{},'' it means that the
2777 compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
2778 definition used does not matter.
2779
2780 @findex STACK_PUSH_CODE
2781 @item STACK_PUSH_CODE
2782
2783 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
2784 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
2785 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
2786
2787 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
2788 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
2789 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
2790 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
2791 space for the next item on the stack.
2792
2793 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
2794 defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
2795 which is often wrong.
2796
2797 @findex FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2798 @item FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2799 Define this macro if the addresses of local variable slots are at negative
2800 offsets from the frame pointer.
2801
2802 @findex ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2803 @item ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2804 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
2805 addresses on the stack.
2806
2807 @findex STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2808 @item STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2809 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
2810
2811 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
2812 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2813 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
2814 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2815 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
2816 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
2817
2818 @findex STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
2819 @item STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
2820 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
2821 The non-zero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
2822
2823 On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is non-zero or where there
2824 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
2825 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
2826 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
2827
2828 @findex STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
2829 @item STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
2830 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
2831 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
2832 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
2833
2834 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2835 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
2836
2837 @findex FIRST_PARM_OFFSET
2838 @item FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2839 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
2840 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
2841 function.
2842
2843 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2844 the first argument's address.
2845
2846 @findex STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET
2847 @item STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2848 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
2849 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
2850
2851 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
2852 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
2853 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
2854
2855 @findex DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS
2856 @item DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
2857 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
2858 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
2859 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
2860 itself.
2861
2862 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
2863 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
2864 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
2865
2866 @findex SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
2867 @item SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
2868 If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
2869 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
2870 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
2871 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
2872 define this macro.
2873
2874 @findex BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
2875 @item BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
2876 If defined, a C expression that contains an rtx that is used to store
2877 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
2878 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
2879 machines. One reason you may need to define this macro is if
2880 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
2881
2882 @findex RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2883 @item RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
2884 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
2885 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
2886 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
2887 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
2888 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
2889
2890 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
2891 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is not way to
2892 determine the return address of other frames.
2893
2894 @findex RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
2895 @item RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
2896 Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
2897 from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
2898
2899 @findex INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2900 @item INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2901 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
2902 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
2903 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
2904 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
2905 the stack.
2906
2907 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
2908 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
2909
2910 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
2911 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
2912
2913 @findex INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
2914 @item INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
2915 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
2916 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
2917 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
2918 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
2919 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
2920
2921 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
2922 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
2923
2924 @findex ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
2925 @item ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2926 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
2927 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
2928 final value should coincide with that calculated by
2929 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
2930 during virtual register instantiation.
2931
2932 The default value for this macro is @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl)},
2933 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
2934 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
2935 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
2936 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
2937
2938 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
2939 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
2940 DWARF 2.
2941
2942 @findex SMALL_STACK
2943 @item SMALL_STACK
2944 Define this macro if the stack size for the target is very small. This
2945 has the effect of disabling gcc's built-in @samp{alloca}, though
2946 @samp{__builtin_alloca} is not affected.
2947 @end table
2948
2949 @node Exception Handling
2950 @subsection Exception Handling Support
2951 @cindex exception handling
2952
2953 @table @code
2954 @findex EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO
2955 @item EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
2956 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
2957 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
2958 @var{N} registers are usable.
2959
2960 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
2961 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
2962 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
2963 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
2964 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
2965
2966 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
2967 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
2968
2969 @findex EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
2970 @item EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
2971 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
2972 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
2973 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
2974 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
2975
2976 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
2977 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
2978
2979 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
2980 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
2981
2982 @findex EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
2983 @item EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
2984 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
2985 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
2986 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
2987
2988 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
2989 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
2990 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
2991 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
2992 frame. @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already been assigned,
2993 so it may be used to calculate the location of the target call frame.
2994
2995 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
2996 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
2997 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
2998
2999 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3000 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3001
3002 @findex ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT
3003 @item ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT(@var{code}, @var{global})
3004 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3005 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3006 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3007 and so may be read-only.
3008
3009 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3010 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3011 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3012 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3013
3014 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3015 represented directly.
3016
3017 @findex ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX
3018 @item ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX(@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3019 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3020 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3021 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3022 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3023
3024 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3025 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3026 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3027 to be emitted.
3028
3029 @findex MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR
3030 @item MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR(@var{context}, @var{fs}, @var{success})
3031 This macro allows the target to add cpu and operating system specific
3032 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3033 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3034 through signal frames.
3035
3036 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in @file{unwind-dw2.c}
3037 and @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3038 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3039 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3040 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register save
3041 addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should branch to
3042 @var{success}. If the frame cannot be decoded, the macro should do
3043 nothing.
3044 @end table
3045
3046 @node Stack Checking
3047 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3048
3049 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of
3050 the stack, if the @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of three ways:
3051
3052 @enumerate
3053 @item
3054 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3055 will assume that you have arranged for stack checking to be done at
3056 appropriate places in the configuration files, e.g., in
3057 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}. GCC will do not other special
3058 processing.
3059
3060 @item
3061 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and you defined a named pattern
3062 called @code{check_stack} in your @file{md} file, GCC will call that
3063 pattern with one argument which is the address to compare the stack
3064 value against. You must arrange for this pattern to report an error if
3065 the stack pointer is out of range.
3066
3067 @item
3068 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3069 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3070 @end enumerate
3071
3072 Normally, you will use the default values of these macros, so GCC
3073 will use the third approach.
3074
3075 @table @code
3076 @findex STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3077 @item STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3078 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3079 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3080 is require by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to have to stack
3081 checking in some more efficient way than GCC's portable approach.
3082 The default value of this macro is zero.
3083
3084 @findex STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL
3085 @item STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL
3086 An integer representing the interval at which GCC must generate stack
3087 probe instructions. You will normally define this macro to be no larger
3088 than the size of the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The
3089 default value of 4096 is suitable for most systems.
3090
3091 @findex STACK_CHECK_PROBE_LOAD
3092 @item STACK_CHECK_PROBE_LOAD
3093 A integer which is nonzero if GCC should perform the stack probe
3094 as a load instruction and zero if GCC should use a store instruction.
3095 The default is zero, which is the most efficient choice on most systems.
3096
3097 @findex STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3098 @item STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3099 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow,
3100 for languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of
3101 75 words should be adequate for most machines.
3102
3103 @findex STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3104 @item STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3105 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3106 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3107 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3108 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3109 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3110 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3111
3112 @findex STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3113 @item STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3114 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3115 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3116 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3117 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3118 use the default of four words.
3119
3120 @findex STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3121 @item STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3122 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3123 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3124 @option{-fstack-check}.
3125 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3126 normally not need to override that default.
3127 @end table
3128
3129 @need 2000
3130 @node Frame Registers
3131 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3132
3133 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3134 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3135
3136 @table @code
3137 @findex STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3138 @item STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3139 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3140 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3141 the hardware determines which register this is.
3142
3143 @findex FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3144 @item FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3145 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3146 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3147 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3148 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3149
3150 @findex HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3151 @item HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3152 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3153 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3154 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3155 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3156 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3157 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3158 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3159 used for the frame pointer.
3160
3161 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3162 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3163 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3164 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3165 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3166 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3167 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3168
3169 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3170 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3171
3172 @findex ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3173 @item ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3174 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3175 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3176 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3177 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3178 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3179 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3180 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3181 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3182
3183 @findex RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3184 @item RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3185 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3186 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3187 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3188 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3189 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3190 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3191
3192 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3193 address from the stack.
3194
3195 @findex STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3196 @findex STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3197 @item STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3198 @itemx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3199 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3200 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3201 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3202 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3203 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3204 not be defined.
3205
3206 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3207
3208 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3209 defined; instead, the next two macros should be defined.
3210
3211 @findex STATIC_CHAIN
3212 @findex STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING
3213 @item STATIC_CHAIN
3214 @itemx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING
3215 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros provide rtx giving
3216 @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3217 @code{STATIC_CHAIN} and @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING} give the locations
3218 as seen by the calling and called functions, respectively. Often the former
3219 will be at an offset from the stack pointer and the latter at an offset from
3220 the frame pointer.
3221
3222 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3223 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3224 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3225 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3226 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized prior to the use of these
3227 macros and should be used to refer to those items.
3228
3229 If the static chain is passed in a register, the two previous macros should
3230 be defined instead.
3231
3232 @findex DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3233 @item DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3234 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3235 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3236 DWARF2 exception handling.
3237
3238 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3239 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3240 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3241 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3242 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3243 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3244 registers that are not call-saved.
3245
3246 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3247 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3248
3249 @findex PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3250 @item PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3251
3252 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3253 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3254
3255 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3256 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3257
3258 @findex DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN
3259 @item DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3260
3261 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3262 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3263 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the interal unwind
3264 column number to use instead.
3265
3266 See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3267
3268 @end table
3269
3270 @node Elimination
3271 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3272
3273 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3274 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3275
3276 @table @code
3277 @findex FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3278 @item FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3279 A C expression which is nonzero if a function must have and use a frame
3280 pointer. This expression is evaluated in the reload pass. If its value is
3281 nonzero the function will have a frame pointer.
3282
3283 The expression can in principle examine the current function and decide
3284 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant 0 or the
3285 constant 1 suffices. Use 0 when the machine allows code to be generated
3286 with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space. Use 1
3287 when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame pointer.
3288
3289 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3290 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3291 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3292 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} says. You don't need to worry about
3293 them.
3294
3295 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3296 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3297 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3298
3299 @findex INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET
3300 @findex get_frame_size
3301 @item INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3302 A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3303 between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3304 the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3305 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3306 registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3307
3308 If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3309 need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3310 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} is defined to always be true; in that
3311 case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3312
3313 @findex ELIMINABLE_REGS
3314 @item ELIMINABLE_REGS
3315 If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3316 eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3317 defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3318 references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3319
3320 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3321 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3322
3323 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3324 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3325 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3326 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3327 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3328
3329 In this case, you might specify:
3330 @example
3331 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3332 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3333 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3334 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3335 @end example
3336
3337 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3338 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3339
3340 @findex CAN_ELIMINATE
3341 @item CAN_ELIMINATE (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg})
3342 A C expression that returns nonzero if the compiler is allowed to try
3343 to replace register number @var{from-reg} with register number
3344 @var{to-reg}. This macro need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3345 is defined, and will usually be the constant 1, since most of the cases
3346 preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3347 knows about.
3348
3349 @findex INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET
3350 @item INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3351 This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3352 specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3353 registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3354 defined.
3355 @end table
3356
3357 @node Stack Arguments
3358 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3359 @cindex arguments on stack
3360 @cindex stack arguments
3361
3362 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3363 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3364 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3365
3366 @table @code
3367 @findex PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3368 @item PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3369 A C expression whose value is nonzero if an argument declared in
3370 a prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should
3371 actually be passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding
3372 errors in certain cases of mismatch, it also makes for better
3373 code on certain machines. If the macro is not defined in target
3374 header files, it defaults to 0.
3375
3376 @findex PUSH_ARGS
3377 @item PUSH_ARGS
3378 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3379 outgoing arguments.
3380 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3381 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3382 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3383 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3384
3385 @findex PUSH_ROUNDING
3386 @item PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3387 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3388 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3389
3390 On some machines, the definition
3391
3392 @example
3393 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3394 @end example
3395
3396 @noindent
3397 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3398 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3399 alignment. Then the definition should be
3400
3401 @example
3402 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3403 @end example
3404
3405 @findex ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3406 @findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3407 @item ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3408 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3409 will be computed and placed into the variable
3410 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3411 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3412 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3413
3414 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3415 is not proper.
3416
3417 @findex REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3418 @item REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3419 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3420 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3421 registers.
3422
3423 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3424 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3425 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3426
3427 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3428 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3429 which.
3430 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3431 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3432
3433 @findex MAYBE_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3434 @findex FINAL_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3435 @item MAYBE_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3436 @itemx FINAL_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{const_size}, @var{var_size})
3437 Define these macros in addition to the one above if functions might
3438 allocate stack space for arguments even when their values are passed
3439 in registers. These should be used when the stack space allocated
3440 for arguments in registers is not a simple constant independent of the
3441 function declaration.
3442
3443 The value of the first macro is the size, in bytes, of the area that
3444 we should initially assume would be reserved for arguments passed in registers.
3445
3446 The value of the second macro is the actual size, in bytes, of the area
3447 that will be reserved for arguments passed in registers. This takes two
3448 arguments: an integer representing the number of bytes of fixed sized
3449 arguments on the stack, and a tree representing the number of bytes of
3450 variable sized arguments on the stack.
3451
3452 When these macros are defined, @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} will only be
3453 called for libcall functions, the current function, or for a function
3454 being called when it is known that such stack space must be allocated.
3455 In each case this value can be easily computed.
3456
3457 When deciding whether a called function needs such stack space, and how
3458 much space to reserve, GCC uses these two macros instead of
3459 @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}.
3460
3461 @findex OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3462 @item OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3463 Define this if it is the responsibility of the caller to allocate the area
3464 reserved for arguments passed in registers.
3465
3466 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3467 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3468 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3469
3470 @findex STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3471 @item STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3472 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3473 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3474 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3475 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3476
3477 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3478 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3479 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3480 stack in its natural location.
3481
3482 @findex RETURN_POPS_ARGS
3483 @item RETURN_POPS_ARGS (@var{fundecl}, @var{funtype}, @var{stack-size})
3484 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes of its own
3485 arguments that a function pops on returning, or 0 if the
3486 function pops no arguments and the caller must therefore pop them all
3487 after the function returns.
3488
3489 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3490 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3491 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3492 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3493
3494 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3495 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3496 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3497 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3498 arguments (if known).
3499
3500 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3501 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3502 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3503 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3504 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3505 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3506
3507 @var{stack-size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3508 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3509 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3510
3511 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3512 of this macro is @var{stack-size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3513 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3514 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3515 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3516 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3517 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3518 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3519 number of arguments.
3520
3521 @findex CALL_POPS_ARGS
3522 @item CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3523 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3524 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3525 when compiling a function call.
3526
3527 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3528 have been accumulated.
3529
3530 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3531 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3532 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3533 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3534 appropriate.
3535
3536 @end table
3537
3538 @node Register Arguments
3539 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3540 @cindex arguments in registers
3541 @cindex registers arguments
3542
3543 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3544 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3545 the stack.
3546
3547 @table @code
3548 @findex FUNCTION_ARG
3549 @item FUNCTION_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3550 A C expression that controls whether a function argument is passed
3551 in a register, and which register.
3552
3553 The arguments are @var{cum}, which summarizes all the previous
3554 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3555 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3556 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3557 which is 1 for an ordinary argument and 0 for nameless arguments that
3558 correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called function's prototype.
3559 @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a syntax error has previously
3560 occurred.
3561
3562 The value of the expression is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the
3563 hard register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the
3564 argument on the stack.
3565
3566 For machines like the VAX and 68000, where normally all arguments are
3567 pushed, zero suffices as a definition.
3568
3569 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3570 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3571 of the @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3572 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3573 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3574 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3575 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3576 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3577 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3578 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3579 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3580 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3581 argument is also stored on the stack.
3582
3583 The last time this macro is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
3584 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3585 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3586
3587 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
3588 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a machine
3589 where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to cause
3590 nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is done
3591 by making @code{FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever @var{named} is 0.
3592
3593 @cindex @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3594 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3595 You may use the macro @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (@var{mode}, @var{type})}
3596 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3597 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
3598 is not defined and @code{FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
3599 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3600 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
3601 a register.
3602
3603 @findex MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
3604 @item MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3605 Define as a C expression that evaluates to nonzero if we do not know how
3606 to pass TYPE solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
3607 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
3608 documentation.
3609
3610 @findex FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
3611 @item FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3612 Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
3613 that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
3614 necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
3615 argument.
3616
3617 For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in which
3618 the caller passes the value, and @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should
3619 be defined in a similar fashion to tell the function being called
3620 where the arguments will arrive.
3621
3622 If @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined, @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3623 serves both purposes.
3624
3625 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS
3626 @item FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3627 A C expression for the number of words, at the beginning of an
3628 argument, that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
3629 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
3630 pushed on the stack.
3631
3632 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
3633 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
3634 first @var{n} words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
3635 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
3636 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
3637 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
3638 compiler when this occurs, and how many of the words should go in
3639 registers.
3640
3641 @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
3642 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
3643 @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
3644
3645 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
3646 @item FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3647 A C expression that indicates when an argument must be passed by reference.
3648 If nonzero for an argument, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
3649 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
3650 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
3651 to that type.
3652
3653 On machines where @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is not defined, a suitable
3654 definition of this macro might be
3655 @smallexample
3656 #define FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE\
3657 (CUM, MODE, TYPE, NAMED) \
3658 MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (MODE, TYPE)
3659 @end smallexample
3660 @c this is *still* too long. --mew 5feb93
3661
3662 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES
3663 @item FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3664 If defined, a C expression that indicates when it is the called function's
3665 responsibility to make a copy of arguments passed by invisible reference.
3666 Normally, the caller makes a copy and passes the address of the copy to the
3667 routine being called. When @code{FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES} is defined and is
3668 nonzero, the caller does not make a copy. Instead, it passes a pointer to the
3669 ``live'' value. The called function must not modify this value. If it can be
3670 determined that the value won't be modified, it need not make a copy;
3671 otherwise a copy must be made.
3672
3673 @findex CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3674 @item CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3675 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument of
3676 @code{FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some target machines,
3677 the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number of bytes of
3678 argument so far.
3679
3680 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
3681 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
3682 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
3683 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
3684 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
3685 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
3686
3687 @findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3688 @item INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname},
3689 @var{fndecl}) A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
3690 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The variable
3691 has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype} is the tree node
3692 for the data type of the function which will receive the args, or 0 if the args
3693 are to a compiler support library function. For direct calls that are not
3694 libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the declaration node of the function.
3695 @var{fndecl} is also set when @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find
3696 arguments for the function being compiled.
3697
3698 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
3699 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
3700 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
3701 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
3702 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
3703 never both of them at once.
3704
3705 @findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS
3706 @item INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
3707 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
3708 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
3709 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
3710 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
3711 0)} is used instead.
3712
3713 @findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS
3714 @item INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
3715 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
3716 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
3717 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
3718
3719 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
3720 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
3721 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
3722 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
3723 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
3724 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
3725
3726 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
3727 @item FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3728 A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable
3729 @var{cum} to advance past an argument in the argument list. The
3730 values @var{mode}, @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.
3731 Once this is done, the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing
3732 the @emph{following} argument with @code{FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
3733
3734 This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
3735 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
3736 used for arguments without any special help.
3737
3738 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING
3739 @item FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3740 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
3741 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
3742 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
3743 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
3744
3745 The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
3746 multiple of @code{FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not control
3747 it.
3748
3749 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
3750 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
3751 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
3752 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
3753
3754 @findex PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
3755 @item PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
3756 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
3757 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
3758 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
3759 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
3760 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
3761
3762 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
3763 @item FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3764 If defined, a C expression that gives the alignment boundary, in bits,
3765 of an argument with the specified mode and type. If it is not defined,
3766 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} is used for all arguments.
3767
3768 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P
3769 @item FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
3770 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
3771 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
3772 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
3773 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
3774 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
3775 stack.
3776
3777 @findex LOAD_ARGS_REVERSED
3778 @item LOAD_ARGS_REVERSED
3779 If defined, the order in which arguments are loaded into their
3780 respective argument registers is reversed so that the last
3781 argument is loaded first. This macro only affects arguments
3782 passed in registers.
3783
3784 @end table
3785
3786 @node Scalar Return
3787 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
3788 @cindex return values in registers
3789 @cindex values, returned by functions
3790 @cindex scalars, returned as values
3791
3792 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
3793 values---values that can fit in registers.
3794
3795 @table @code
3796 @findex FUNCTION_VALUE
3797 @item FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
3798 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a
3799 function returns a value of data type @var{valtype}. @var{valtype} is
3800 a tree node representing a data type. Write @code{TYPE_MODE
3801 (@var{valtype})} to get the machine mode used to represent that type.
3802 On many machines, only the mode is relevant. (Actually, on most
3803 machines, scalar values are returned in the same place regardless of
3804 mode).
3805
3806 The value of the expression is usually a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3807 register where the return value is stored. The value can also be a
3808 @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in multiple places. See
3809 @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the @code{parallel} form.
3810
3811 If @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} is defined, you must apply the same
3812 promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if @var{valtype} is a
3813 scalar type.
3814
3815 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
3816 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
3817 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
3818 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
3819 known.
3820
3821 @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return vales with aggregate data
3822 types, because these are returned in another way. See
3823 @code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} and related macros, below.
3824
3825 @findex FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE
3826 @item FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
3827 Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows''
3828 so that the register in which a function returns its value is not
3829 the same as the one in which the caller sees the value.
3830
3831 For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} computes the register in which
3832 the caller will see the value. @code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} should be
3833 defined in a similar fashion to tell the function where to put the
3834 value.
3835
3836 If @code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} is not defined,
3837 @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} serves both purposes.
3838
3839 @code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} is not used for return vales with
3840 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
3841 @code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} and related macros, below.
3842
3843 @findex LIBCALL_VALUE
3844 @item LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
3845 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
3846 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}. If the precise function
3847 being called is known, @var{func} is a tree node
3848 (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
3849 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
3850 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
3851 known.
3852
3853 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
3854 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
3855 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
3856 compiled.
3857
3858 The definition of @code{LIBRARY_VALUE} need not be concerned aggregate
3859 data types, because none of the library functions returns such types.
3860
3861 @findex FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
3862 @item FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
3863 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
3864 register in which the values of called function may come back.
3865
3866 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
3867 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
3868 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
3869 suffices:
3870
3871 @example
3872 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
3873 @end example
3874
3875 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
3876 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
3877 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
3878
3879 @findex APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
3880 @item APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
3881 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
3882 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
3883 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
3884 @end table
3885
3886 @node Aggregate Return
3887 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
3888 @cindex aggregates as return values
3889 @cindex large return values
3890 @cindex returning aggregate values
3891 @cindex structure value address
3892
3893 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
3894 cases), the value is not returned according to @code{FUNCTION_VALUE}
3895 (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the caller passes the address of a
3896 block of memory in which the value should be stored. This address
3897 is called the @dfn{structure value address}.
3898
3899 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
3900 memory.
3901
3902 @table @code
3903 @findex RETURN_IN_MEMORY
3904 @item RETURN_IN_MEMORY (@var{type})
3905 A C expression which can inhibit the returning of certain function
3906 values in registers, based on the type of value. A nonzero value says
3907 to return the function value in memory, just as large structures are
3908 always returned. Here @var{type} will be a C expression of type
3909 @code{tree}, representing the data type of the value.
3910
3911 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
3912 by this macro. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
3913 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
3914 possible to leave the macro undefined; this causes a default
3915 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
3916 values, and 0 otherwise.
3917
3918 Do not use this macro to indicate that structures and unions should always
3919 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
3920 to indicate this.
3921
3922 @findex DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
3923 @item DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
3924 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
3925 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
3926 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
3927 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
3928 and union return values are decided by the @code{RETURN_IN_MEMORY} macro.
3929
3930 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
3931
3932 @findex STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM
3933 @item STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM
3934 If the structure value address is passed in a register, then
3935 @code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} should be the number of that register.
3936
3937 @findex STRUCT_VALUE
3938 @item STRUCT_VALUE
3939 If the structure value address is not passed in a register, define
3940 @code{STRUCT_VALUE} as an expression returning an RTX for the place
3941 where the address is passed. If it returns 0, the address is passed as
3942 an ``invisible'' first argument.
3943
3944 @findex STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING_REGNUM
3945 @item STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING_REGNUM
3946 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
3947 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
3948 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
3949 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
3950
3951 If the incoming location of the structure value address is in a
3952 register, define this macro as the register number.
3953
3954 @findex STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING
3955 @item STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING
3956 If the incoming location is not a register, then you should define
3957 @code{STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING} as an expression for an RTX for where the
3958 called function should find the value. If it should find the value on
3959 the stack, define this to create a @code{mem} which refers to the frame
3960 pointer. A definition of 0 means that the address is passed as an
3961 ``invisible'' first argument.
3962
3963 @findex PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
3964 @item PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
3965 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
3966 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
3967 the address of a static variable containing the value.
3968
3969 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
3970 pass an address to the subroutine.
3971
3972 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
3973 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
3974 @end table
3975
3976 @node Caller Saves
3977 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
3978
3979 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
3980 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
3981 must live across calls.
3982
3983 @table @code
3984 @findex DEFAULT_CALLER_SAVES
3985 @item DEFAULT_CALLER_SAVES
3986 Define this macro if function calls on the target machine do not preserve
3987 any registers; in other words, if @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} has 1
3988 for all registers. When defined, this macro enables @option{-fcaller-saves}
3989 by default for all optimization levels. It has no effect for optimization
3990 levels 2 and higher, where @option{-fcaller-saves} is the default.
3991
3992 @findex CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE
3993 @item CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
3994 A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
3995 a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
3996 restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
3997 this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
3998
3999 If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4000 machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4001
4002 @findex HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE
4003 @item HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4004 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4005 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4006 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4007 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4008 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4009 @end table
4010
4011 @node Function Entry
4012 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4013 @cindex function entry and exit
4014 @cindex prologue
4015 @cindex epilogue
4016
4017 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4018 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4019
4020 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4021 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4022 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4023 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4024 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4025 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4026 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4027
4028 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4029 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4030
4031 @findex regs_ever_live
4032 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4033 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4034 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4035 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4036 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4037 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4038
4039 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4040 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4041 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4042 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4043 registers are used in the function.
4044
4045 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4046 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4047 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4048 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4049 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4050 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4051 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4052
4053 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4054 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4055 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4056 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4057 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4058 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4059 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4060 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4061 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4062 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4063 @end deftypefn
4064
4065 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4066 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4067 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4068 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4069 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4070 @end deftypefn
4071
4072 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4073 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4074 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4075 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4076 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4077 @end deftypefn
4078
4079 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4080 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4081 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4082 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4083 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4084 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4085 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4086 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4087
4088 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4089 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4090 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4091 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4092
4093 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4094 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4095 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4096 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4097 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4098 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4099
4100 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4101 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4102 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4103 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4104 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4105 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4106
4107 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4108 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4109 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4110 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4111
4112 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4113 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4114 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4115 number of arguments.
4116
4117 @findex current_function_pops_args
4118 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4119 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4120 needs to know what was decided. The variable that is called
4121 @code{current_function_pops_args} is the number of bytes of its
4122 arguments that a function should pop. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4123 @c what is the "its arguments" in the above sentence referring to, pray
4124 @c tell? --mew 5feb93
4125 @end deftypefn
4126
4127 @table @code
4128
4129 @itemize @bullet
4130 @item
4131 @findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4132 A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4133 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4134 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4135 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4136 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4137 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4138 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4139 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4140 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4141
4142 @item
4143 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4144 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4145 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4146 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4147 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4148 a save area.
4149
4150 @item
4151 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4152 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4153 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4154 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4155
4156 @item
4157 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4158 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4159 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4160 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4161 @end itemize
4162
4163 Normally, it is necessary for the macros
4164 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4165 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to treat leaf functions specially.
4166 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4167 function.
4168
4169 @findex EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4170 @item EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4171 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4172 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4173 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4174 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function.
4175
4176 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4177 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4178 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4179 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4180
4181 @findex EPILOGUE_USES
4182 @item EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4183 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4184 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4185 pointer registers are already be assumed to be used as needed.
4186
4187 @findex EH_USES
4188 @item EH_USES (@var{regno})
4189 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4190 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4191 on entry to an exception edge.
4192
4193 @findex DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4194 @item DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4195 Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4196 instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4197 definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4198 representing the number of delay slots there.
4199
4200 @findex ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY
4201 @item ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4202 A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4203 slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4204
4205 The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4206 being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4207 eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4208 of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4209 If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4210 may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4211 (at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4212 slot.
4213
4214 @findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4215 @findex final_scan_insn
4216 The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4217 list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4218 @code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4219 delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4220 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4221 outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4222 @code{final_scan_insn}.
4223
4224 You need not define this macro if you did not define
4225 @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4226
4227 @end table
4228
4229 @findex TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4230 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, tree @var{function})
4231 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4232 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4233 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4234 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4235 the real function.
4236
4237 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4238 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4239 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4240 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4241 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4242 all other incoming arguments.
4243
4244 After the addition, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4245 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4246 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4247 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4248
4249 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4250 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4251 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4252 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4253
4254 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4255 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4256 some targets, but probably not.
4257
4258 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4259 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4260 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4261 not support varargs.
4262 @end deftypefn
4263
4264 @findex TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_VCALL_THUNK
4265 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_VCALL_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, int @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4266 A function like @code{TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK}, except that if
4267 @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be made
4268 after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4269 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4270
4271 @example
4272 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4273 @end example
4274
4275 @noindent
4276 If this function is defined, it will always be used in place of
4277 @code{TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK}.
4278
4279 @end deftypefn
4280
4281 @node Profiling
4282 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4283 @cindex profiling, code generation
4284
4285 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4286
4287 @table @code
4288 @findex FUNCTION_PROFILER
4289 @item FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4290 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4291 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4292
4293 @findex mcount
4294 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4295 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4296 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4297 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4298
4299 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4300 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4301 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4302 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4303
4304 @findex PROFILE_HOOK
4305 @item PROFILE_HOOK
4306 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4307 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4308 not support profiling.
4309
4310 @findex NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4311 @item NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4312 Define this macro if the @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does
4313 not need a counter variable allocated for each function. This is true
4314 for almost all modern implementations. If you define this macro, you
4315 must not use the @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4316
4317 @findex PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4318 @item PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4319 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4320 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4321 @end table
4322
4323 @node Tail Calls
4324 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4325 @cindex tail calls
4326
4327 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4328 True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4329 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4330 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4331
4332 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4333 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4334 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4335 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4336 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4337 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4338 @end deftypefn
4339
4340 @node Varargs
4341 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4342 @cindex varargs implementation
4343
4344 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4345 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4346 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4347 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4348 conditionals to include it.
4349
4350 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4351 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4352 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4353 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4354 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4355 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4356
4357 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4358 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4359 below.
4360
4361 @table @code
4362 @findex __builtin_saveregs
4363 @item __builtin_saveregs ()
4364 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4365 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4366 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4367 you use @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4368
4369 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4370 control of the macro @code{EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On other machines,
4371 it calls a routine written in assembler language, found in
4372 @file{libgcc2.c}.
4373
4374 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4375 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4376 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4377 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4378 to use them for its own purposes.
4379 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4380 @c 10feb93
4381
4382 @findex __builtin_args_info
4383 @item __builtin_args_info (@var{category})
4384 Use this built-in function to find the first anonymous arguments in
4385 registers.
4386
4387 In general, a machine may have several categories of registers used for
4388 arguments, each for a particular category of data types. (For example,
4389 on some machines, floating-point registers are used for floating-point
4390 arguments while other arguments are passed in the general registers.)
4391 To make non-varargs functions use the proper calling convention, you
4392 have defined the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data type to record how many
4393 registers in each category have been used so far
4394
4395 @code{__builtin_args_info} accesses the same data structure of type
4396 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} after the ordinary argument layout is finished
4397 with it, with @var{category} specifying which word to access. Thus, the
4398 value indicates the first unused register in a given category.
4399
4400 Normally, you would use @code{__builtin_args_info} in the implementation
4401 of @code{va_start}, accessing each category just once and storing the
4402 value in the @code{va_list} object. This is because @code{va_list} will
4403 have to update the values, and there is no way to alter the
4404 values accessed by @code{__builtin_args_info}.
4405
4406 @findex __builtin_next_arg
4407 @item __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
4408 This is the equivalent of @code{__builtin_args_info}, for stack
4409 arguments. It returns the address of the first anonymous stack
4410 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4411 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4412 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4413 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4414 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4415 of the current function.
4416
4417 @findex __builtin_classify_type
4418 @item __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4419 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4420 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4421 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
4422 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4423 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4424
4425 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4426 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
4427 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4428
4429 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4430 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4431 @end table
4432
4433 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4434
4435 @table @code
4436 @findex EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
4437 @item EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS ()
4438 If defined, is a C expression that produces the machine-specific code
4439 for a call to @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the
4440 very beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made.
4441 The return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the
4442 value to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
4443
4444 @findex SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
4445 @item SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (@var{args_so_far}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{pretend_args_size}, @var{second_time})
4446 This macro offers an alternative to using @code{__builtin_saveregs} and
4447 defining the macro @code{EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the
4448 anonymous register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments
4449 appear to have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is
4450 done, you can use the standard implementation of varargs that works for
4451 machines that pass all their arguments on the stack.
4452
4453 The argument @var{args_so_far} is the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
4454 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
4455 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
4456 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
4457
4458 The macro implementation should do two things: first, push onto the
4459 stack all the argument registers @emph{not} used for the named
4460 arguments, and second, store the size of the data thus pushed into the
4461 @code{int}-valued variable whose name is supplied as the argument
4462 @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you store here will serve as
4463 additional offset for setting up the stack frame.
4464
4465 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
4466 compile time without knowing their data types,
4467 @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that have just
4468 a single category of argument register and use it uniformly for all data
4469 types.
4470
4471 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
4472 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
4473 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
4474 end of the source file. The macro @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
4475 not generate any instructions in this case.
4476
4477 @findex STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
4478 @item STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
4479 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the location where a function
4480 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
4481
4482 This macro controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4483 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this macro returns a
4484 nonzero value, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
4485 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns a value of
4486 zero, but @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is defined, then all arguments
4487 are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments except the last
4488 are treated as named.
4489
4490 You need not define this macro if it always returns zero.
4491
4492 @findex PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
4493 @item PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
4494 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
4495 @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
4496 @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
4497 defined, then define this macro to return nonzero if
4498 @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, zero otherwise.
4499 Otherwise, you should not define this macro.
4500 @end table
4501
4502 @node Trampolines
4503 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
4504 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
4505 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
4506
4507 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
4508 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
4509 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
4510 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
4511 trampoline.
4512
4513 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
4514 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
4515 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
4516 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
4517 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
4518 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
4519 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
4520 operands.
4521
4522 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
4523 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
4524 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
4525 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
4526 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
4527 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
4528 separately.
4529
4530 @table @code
4531 @findex TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
4532 @item TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (@var{file})
4533 A C statement to output, on the stream @var{file}, assembler code for a
4534 block of data that contains the constant parts of a trampoline. This
4535 code should not include a label---the label is taken care of
4536 automatically.
4537
4538 If you do not define this macro, it means no template is needed
4539 for the target. Do not define this macro on systems where the block move
4540 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
4541 to generate it on the spot.
4542
4543 @findex TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
4544 @item TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
4545 The name of a subroutine to switch to the section in which the
4546 trampoline template is to be placed (@pxref{Sections}). The default is
4547 a value of @samp{readonly_data_section}, which places the trampoline in
4548 the section containing read-only data.
4549
4550 @findex TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
4551 @item TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
4552 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
4553
4554 @findex TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
4555 @item TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
4556 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
4557
4558 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
4559 is used for aligning trampolines.
4560
4561 @findex INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE
4562 @item INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE (@var{addr}, @var{fnaddr}, @var{static_chain})
4563 A C statement to initialize the variable parts of a trampoline.
4564 @var{addr} is an RTX for the address of the trampoline; @var{fnaddr} is
4565 an RTX for the address of the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
4566 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
4567 when it is called.
4568
4569 @findex TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
4570 @item TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (@var{addr})
4571 A C statement that should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
4572 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address that
4573 was passed to @code{INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE}. In case the address to be
4574 used for a function call should be different from the address in which
4575 the template was stored, the different address should be assigned to
4576 @var{addr}. If this macro is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for
4577 function calls.
4578
4579 @findex ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE
4580 @item ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE (@var{fp})
4581 A C expression to allocate run-time space for a trampoline. The
4582 expression value should be an RTX representing a memory reference to the
4583 space for the trampoline.
4584
4585 @cindex @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} and trampolines
4586 @cindex @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and trampolines
4587 If this macro is not defined, by default the trampoline is allocated as
4588 a stack slot. This default is right for most machines. The exceptions
4589 are machines where it is impossible to execute instructions in the stack
4590 area. On such machines, you may have to implement a separate stack,
4591 using this macro in conjunction with @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4592 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}.
4593
4594 @var{fp} points to a data structure, a @code{struct function}, which
4595 describes the compilation status of the immediate containing function of
4596 the function which the trampoline is for. Normally (when
4597 @code{ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE} is not defined), the stack slot for the
4598 trampoline is in the stack frame of this containing function. Other
4599 allocation strategies probably must do something analogous with this
4600 information.
4601 @end table
4602
4603 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
4604 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
4605 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
4606 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
4607
4608 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
4609 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
4610 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
4611 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
4612 latter makes initialization faster.
4613
4614 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
4615 the following macros which describe the shape of the cache.
4616
4617 @table @code
4618 @findex INSN_CACHE_SIZE
4619 @item INSN_CACHE_SIZE
4620 The total size in bytes of the cache.
4621
4622 @findex INSN_CACHE_LINE_WIDTH
4623 @item INSN_CACHE_LINE_WIDTH
4624 The length in bytes of each cache line. The cache is divided into cache
4625 lines which are disjoint slots, each holding a contiguous chunk of data
4626 fetched from memory. Each time data is brought into the cache, an
4627 entire line is read at once. The data loaded into a cache line is
4628 always aligned on a boundary equal to the line size.
4629
4630 @findex INSN_CACHE_DEPTH
4631 @item INSN_CACHE_DEPTH
4632 The number of alternative cache lines that can hold any particular memory
4633 location.
4634 @end table
4635
4636 Alternatively, if the machine has system calls or instructions to clear
4637 the instruction cache directly, you can define the following macro.
4638
4639 @table @code
4640 @findex CLEAR_INSN_CACHE
4641 @item CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
4642 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
4643 cache} in the specified interval. If it is not defined, and the macro
4644 @code{INSN_CACHE_SIZE} is defined, some generic code is generated to clear the
4645 cache. The definition of this macro would typically be a series of
4646 @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and @var{end} are both pointer
4647 expressions.
4648 @end table
4649
4650 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
4651 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
4652 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
4653 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
4654 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
4655
4656 @table @code
4657 @findex TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
4658 @item TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
4659 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
4660 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
4661 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
4662 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
4663
4664 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
4665 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
4666 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
4667 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
4668 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
4669 special assembler code.
4670 @end table
4671
4672 @node Library Calls
4673 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
4674 @cindex library subroutine names
4675 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
4676
4677 @c prevent bad page break with this line
4678 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
4679
4680 @table @code
4681 @findex MULSI3_LIBCALL
4682 @item MULSI3_LIBCALL
4683 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4684 multiplication of one signed full-word by another. If you do not
4685 define this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__mulsi3},
4686 a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4687
4688 @findex DIVSI3_LIBCALL
4689 @item DIVSI3_LIBCALL
4690 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4691 division of one signed full-word by another. If you do not define
4692 this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__divsi3}, a
4693 function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4694
4695 @findex UDIVSI3_LIBCALL
4696 @item UDIVSI3_LIBCALL
4697 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4698 division of one unsigned full-word by another. If you do not define
4699 this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__udivsi3}, a
4700 function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4701
4702 @findex MODSI3_LIBCALL
4703 @item MODSI3_LIBCALL
4704 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4705 remainder in division of one signed full-word by another. If you do
4706 not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4707 @code{__modsi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4708
4709 @findex UMODSI3_LIBCALL
4710 @item UMODSI3_LIBCALL
4711 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4712 remainder in division of one unsigned full-word by another. If you do
4713 not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4714 @code{__umodsi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4715
4716 @findex MULDI3_LIBCALL
4717 @item MULDI3_LIBCALL
4718 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4719 multiplication of one signed double-word by another. If you do not
4720 define this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__muldi3},
4721 a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4722
4723 @findex DIVDI3_LIBCALL
4724 @item DIVDI3_LIBCALL
4725 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4726 division of one signed double-word by another. If you do not define
4727 this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__divdi3}, a
4728 function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4729
4730 @findex UDIVDI3_LIBCALL
4731 @item UDIVDI3_LIBCALL
4732 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4733 division of one unsigned full-word by another. If you do not define
4734 this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__udivdi3}, a
4735 function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4736
4737 @findex MODDI3_LIBCALL
4738 @item MODDI3_LIBCALL
4739 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4740 remainder in division of one signed double-word by another. If you do
4741 not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4742 @code{__moddi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4743
4744 @findex UMODDI3_LIBCALL
4745 @item UMODDI3_LIBCALL
4746 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4747 remainder in division of one unsigned full-word by another. If you do
4748 not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4749 @code{__umoddi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4750
4751 @findex DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
4752 @item DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
4753 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
4754 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
4755 provide alternate names for gcc's internal library functions if there
4756 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
4757
4758 @findex INIT_TARGET_OPTABS
4759 @item INIT_TARGET_OPTABS
4760 Define this macro as a C statement that declares additional library
4761 routines renames existing ones. @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after
4762 initializing all the normal library routines.
4763
4764 @findex FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
4765 @item FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL
4766 Define this macro as a C statement that returns nonzero if a call to
4767 the floating point comparison library function will return a boolean
4768 value that indicates the result of the comparison. It should return
4769 zero if one of gcc's own libgcc functions is called.
4770
4771 Most ports don't need to define this macro.
4772
4773 @findex TARGET_EDOM
4774 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
4775 @item TARGET_EDOM
4776 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
4777 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
4778 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
4779 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
4780 system.
4781
4782 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
4783 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
4784 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
4785 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
4786 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
4787
4788 @findex GEN_ERRNO_RTX
4789 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
4790 @item GEN_ERRNO_RTX
4791 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
4792 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
4793 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
4794 macro, a reasonable default is used.
4795
4796 @findex TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
4797 @cindex @code{bcopy}, implicit usage
4798 @cindex @code{memcpy}, implicit usage
4799 @cindex @code{memmove}, implicit usage
4800 @cindex @code{bzero}, implicit usage
4801 @cindex @code{memset}, implicit usage
4802 @item TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
4803 Define this macro if GCC should generate calls to the ISO C
4804 (and System V) library functions @code{memcpy}, @code{memmove} and
4805 @code{memset} rather than the BSD functions @code{bcopy} and @code{bzero}.
4806
4807 @findex TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
4808 @cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
4809 @item TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
4810 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
4811 @code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
4812 default is nonzero that should be proper value for most modern systems, however
4813 number of existing systems lacks support for these functions in the runtime so
4814 they needs this macro to be redefined to 0.
4815
4816 @findex LIBGCC_NEEDS_DOUBLE
4817 @item LIBGCC_NEEDS_DOUBLE
4818 Define this macro if @code{float} arguments cannot be passed to library
4819 routines (so they must be converted to @code{double}). This macro
4820 affects both how library calls are generated and how the library
4821 routines in @file{libgcc.a} accept their arguments. It is useful on
4822 machines where floating and fixed point arguments are passed
4823 differently, such as the i860.
4824
4825 @findex NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
4826 @item NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
4827 Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
4828 the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
4829 involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
4830 at once to the method-lookup library function.
4831
4832 The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
4833 to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
4834 @end table
4835
4836 @node Addressing Modes
4837 @section Addressing Modes
4838 @cindex addressing modes
4839
4840 @c prevent bad page break with this line
4841 This is about addressing modes.
4842
4843 @table @code
4844 @findex HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
4845 @findex HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
4846 @findex HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
4847 @findex HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
4848 @item HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
4849 @itemx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
4850 @itemx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
4851 @itemx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
4852 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
4853 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
4854
4855 @findex HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
4856 @findex HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
4857 @item HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
4858 @itemx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
4859 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
4860 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
4861 the size of the memory operand.
4862
4863 @findex HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
4864 @findex HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
4865 @item HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
4866 @itemx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
4867 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
4868 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
4869
4870 @findex CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P
4871 @item CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
4872 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
4873 is a valid address. On most machines, this can be defined as
4874 @code{CONSTANT_P (@var{x})}, but a few machines are more restrictive
4875 in which constant addresses are supported.
4876
4877 @findex CONSTANT_P
4878 @code{CONSTANT_P} accepts integer-values expressions whose values are
4879 not explicitly known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and
4880 @code{high} expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in
4881 addition to @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
4882
4883 @findex MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
4884 @item MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
4885 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
4886 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
4887 the maximum number that @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} would ever
4888 accept.
4889
4890 @findex GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS
4891 @item GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
4892 A C compound statement with a conditional @code{goto @var{label};}
4893 executed if @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory address on the
4894 target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
4895
4896 It usually pays to define several simpler macros to serve as
4897 subroutines for this one. Otherwise it may be too complicated to
4898 understand.
4899
4900 This macro must exist in two variants: a strict variant and a
4901 non-strict one. The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It
4902 must be defined so that any pseudo-register that has not been
4903 allocated a hard register is considered a memory reference. In
4904 contexts where some kind of register is required, a pseudo-register
4905 with no hard register must be rejected.
4906
4907 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
4908 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
4909 register is required.
4910
4911 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
4912 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
4913 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
4914 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant
4915 in that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
4916
4917 Subroutines to check for acceptable registers for various purposes (one
4918 for base registers, one for index registers, and so on) are typically
4919 among the subroutines used to define @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}.
4920 Then only these subroutine macros need have two variants; the higher
4921 levels of macros may be the same whether strict or not.
4922
4923 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
4924 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
4925 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
4926 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
4927 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
4928
4929 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
4930 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
4931 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
4932 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
4933 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
4934
4935 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
4936 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
4937 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
4938 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
4939 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
4940 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
4941 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
4942 Format}.
4943
4944 @findex saveable_obstack
4945 The best way to modify the name string is by adding text to the
4946 beginning, with suitable punctuation to prevent any ambiguity. Allocate
4947 the new name in @code{saveable_obstack}. You will have to modify
4948 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to remove and decode the added text and
4949 output the name accordingly, and define @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING}
4950 to access the original name string.
4951
4952 You can check the information stored here into the @code{symbol_ref} in
4953 the definitions of the macros @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} and
4954 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
4955
4956 @findex REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P
4957 @item REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{x})
4958 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} (assumed to be a @code{reg}
4959 RTX) is valid for use as a base register. For hard registers, it
4960 should always accept those which the hardware permits and reject the
4961 others. Whether the macro accepts or rejects pseudo registers must be
4962 controlled by @code{REG_OK_STRICT} as described above. This usually
4963 requires two variant definitions, of which @code{REG_OK_STRICT}
4964 controls the one actually used.
4965
4966 @findex REG_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P
4967 @item REG_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{x}, @var{mode})
4968 A C expression that is just like @code{REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
4969 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
4970 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
4971 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
4972 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
4973 @code{REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
4974
4975 @findex REG_OK_FOR_INDEX_P
4976 @item REG_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{x})
4977 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} (assumed to be a @code{reg}
4978 RTX) is valid for use as an index register.
4979
4980 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
4981 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
4982 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
4983 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
4984 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
4985 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
4986 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
4987 only if neither labeling works.
4988
4989 @findex FIND_BASE_TERM
4990 @item FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
4991 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x}.
4992 This macro is used in only one place: `find_base_term' in alias.c.
4993
4994 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
4995 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
4996
4997 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
4998 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
4999
5000 @findex LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5001 @item LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{oldx}, @var{mode}, @var{win})
5002 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x} with a valid
5003 memory address for an operand of mode @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a
5004 C statement label elsewhere in the code; the macro definition may use
5005
5006 @example
5007 GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{win});
5008 @end example
5009
5010 @noindent
5011 to avoid further processing if the address has become legitimate.
5012
5013 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5014 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5015 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5016 @var{x}.
5017
5018 The code generated by this macro should not alter the substructure of
5019 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5020 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5021
5022 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5023 address. The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In
5024 fact, it is safe for this macro to do nothing. But often a
5025 machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5026
5027 @findex LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS
5028 @item LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5029 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5030 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5031 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5032 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5033 performance reasons.
5034
5035 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5036 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5037 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5038 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5039 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5040 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5041 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5042 be shared.
5043
5044 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5045 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5046 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5047 of reload internals.
5048
5049 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5050 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5051 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5052
5053 @findex push_reload
5054 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5055 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5056 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5057
5058 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5059 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5060 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5061 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5062 @code{push_reload}.
5063
5064 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5065 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5066 the address has become legitimate.
5067
5068 @findex copy_rtx
5069 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5070 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that is unshares only a
5071 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5072 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5073 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5074 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5075
5076 @findex GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS
5077 @item GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5078 A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5079 @var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5080 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5081 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5082 but not others.
5083
5084 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5085 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5086 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5087 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5088
5089 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5090
5091 @findex LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
5092 @item LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5093 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for
5094 an immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5095 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this. In fact,
5096 @samp{1} is a suitable definition for this macro on machines where
5097 anything @code{CONSTANT_P} is valid.
5098 @end table
5099
5100 @node Condition Code
5101 @section Condition Code Status
5102 @cindex condition code status
5103
5104 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5105 This describes the condition code status.
5106
5107 @findex cc_status
5108 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5109 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5110 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5111 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5112 currently based, and several standard flags.
5113
5114 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5115 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5116 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5117
5118 @table @code
5119 @findex CC_STATUS_MDEP
5120 @item CC_STATUS_MDEP
5121 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5122 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5123
5124 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5125
5126 @findex CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5127 @item CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5128 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5129 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5130 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5131 define this macro to initialize it.
5132
5133 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5134
5135 @findex NOTICE_UPDATE_CC
5136 @item NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5137 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5138 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5139 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5140 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5141 set @code{(cc0)}.
5142
5143 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5144
5145 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5146 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5147 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5148 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5149 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5150 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5151 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5152 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5153 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5154 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5155 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5156 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5157 condition code value.
5158
5159 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5160 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5161 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5162 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5163 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5164 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5165 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5166
5167 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5168 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5169 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5170 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5171
5172 @findex EXTRA_CC_MODES
5173 @item EXTRA_CC_MODES
5174 Condition codes are represented in registers by machine modes of class
5175 @code{MODE_CC}. By default, there is just one mode, @code{CCmode}, with
5176 this class. If you need more such modes, create a file named
5177 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} in your @file{config/@var{machine}}
5178 directory (@pxref{Back End, , Anatomy of a Target Back End}), containing
5179 a list of these modes. Each entry in the list should be a call to the
5180 macro @code{CC}. This macro takes one argument, which is the name of
5181 the mode: it should begin with @samp{CC}. Do not put quotation marks
5182 around the name, or include the trailing @samp{mode}; these are
5183 automatically added. There should not be anything else in the file
5184 except comments.
5185
5186 A sample @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} file might look like this:
5187
5188 @smallexample
5189 CC (CC_NOOV) /* @r{Comparison only valid if there was no overflow.} */
5190 CC (CCFP) /* @r{Floating point comparison that cannot trap.} */
5191 CC (CCFPE) /* @r{Floating point comparison that may trap.} */
5192 @end smallexample
5193
5194 When you create this file, the macro @code{EXTRA_CC_MODES} is
5195 automatically defined by @command{configure}, with value @samp{1}.
5196
5197 @findex SELECT_CC_MODE
5198 @item SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5199 Returns a mode from class @code{MODE_CC} to be used when comparison
5200 operation code @var{op} is applied to rtx @var{x} and @var{y}. For
5201 example, on the SPARC, @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} is defined as (see
5202 @pxref{Jump Patterns} for a description of the reason for this
5203 definition)
5204
5205 @smallexample
5206 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5207 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5208 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
5209 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5210 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5211 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5212 @end smallexample
5213
5214 You need not define this macro if @code{EXTRA_CC_MODES} is not defined.
5215
5216 @findex CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON
5217 @item CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
5218 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
5219 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5220 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5221 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5222
5223 On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
5224 required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
5225 and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
5226 comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
5227 @var{op1} as required.
5228
5229 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
5230 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
5231 @file{md} file.
5232
5233 You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
5234 code or operands.
5235
5236 @findex REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE
5237 @item REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
5238 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
5239 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
5240 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
5241 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
5242
5243 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
5244 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
5245 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
5246 inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
5247
5248 @smallexample
5249 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
5250 @end smallexample
5251
5252 @findex REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
5253 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
5254 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
5255 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
5256 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
5257 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
5258 freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
5259 like:
5260
5261 @smallexample
5262 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
5263 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
5264 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
5265 @end smallexample
5266
5267 @findex REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P
5268 @item REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{code1}, @var{code2})
5269 A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
5270 @var{code1} is the inverse of @var{code2} and vice versa. Define this to
5271 return 0 if the target has conditional execution predicates that cannot be
5272 reversed safely. If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as
5273 follows:
5274
5275 @smallexample
5276 #define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
5277 ((x) == reverse_condition (y))
5278 @end smallexample
5279
5280 @end table
5281
5282 @node Costs
5283 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
5284 @cindex costs of instructions
5285 @cindex relative costs
5286 @cindex speed of instructions
5287
5288 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
5289 on the target machine.
5290
5291 @table @code
5292 @findex REGISTER_MOVE_COST
5293 @item REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
5294 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
5295 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
5296 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
5297 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
5298 that.
5299
5300 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
5301 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
5302 registers if they are not general registers.
5303
5304 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
5305 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
5306 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
5307 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
5308 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
5309 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
5310
5311 @findex MEMORY_MOVE_COST
5312 @item MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
5313 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
5314 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
5315 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
5316 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
5317 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
5318 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
5319
5320 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
5321 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
5322 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
5323 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
5324 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
5325 reflect the actual cost of the move.
5326
5327 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
5328 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
5329 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
5330 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
5331 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
5332 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
5333 are the same as to this macro.
5334
5335 @findex BRANCH_COST
5336 @item BRANCH_COST
5337 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
5338 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that.
5339 @end table
5340
5341 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
5342 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
5343 ordinarily expect.
5344
5345 @table @code
5346 @findex SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
5347 @item SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
5348 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
5349 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
5350 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
5351 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
5352 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
5353
5354 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
5355 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
5356 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
5357 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
5358 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
5359 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
5360
5361 @findex SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
5362 @item SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
5363 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
5364 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
5365 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
5366 handler.
5367
5368 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
5369 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
5370 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
5371 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
5372 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
5373
5374 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
5375 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
5376 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
5377
5378 @findex DONT_REDUCE_ADDR
5379 @item DONT_REDUCE_ADDR
5380 Define this macro to inhibit strength reduction of memory addresses.
5381 (On some machines, such strength reduction seems to do harm rather
5382 than good.)
5383
5384 @findex MOVE_RATIO
5385 @item MOVE_RATIO
5386 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
5387 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
5388 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
5389 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
5390
5391 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
5392 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
5393 the number of such sequences.
5394
5395 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
5396
5397 @findex MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
5398 @item MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
5399 A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
5400 copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
5401 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
5402 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
5403
5404 @findex MOVE_MAX_PIECES
5405 @item MOVE_MAX_PIECES
5406 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
5407 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
5408
5409 @findex CLEAR_RATIO
5410 @item CLEAR_RATIO
5411 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
5412 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
5413 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
5414 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
5415
5416 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
5417
5418 @findex CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P
5419 @item CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
5420 A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
5421 to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
5422 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
5423 than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
5424
5425 @findex STORE_BY_PIECES_P
5426 @item STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
5427 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
5428 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some other
5429 mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when storing
5430 values other than constant zero and by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
5431 when called with a constant source string.
5432 Defaults to @code{MOVE_BY_PIECES_P}.
5433
5434 @findex USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT
5435 @item USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5436 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
5437 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5438 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
5439
5440 @findex USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT
5441 @item USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5442 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
5443 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5444 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
5445
5446 @findex USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT
5447 @item USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5448 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
5449 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5450 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
5451
5452 @findex USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT
5453 @item USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5454 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
5455 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5456 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
5457
5458 @findex USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT
5459 @item USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5460 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
5461 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5462 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
5463
5464 @findex USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT
5465 @item USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5466 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
5467 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5468 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
5469
5470 @findex USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT
5471 @item USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5472 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
5473 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5474 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
5475
5476 @findex USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT
5477 @item USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5478 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
5479 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5480 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
5481
5482 @findex NO_FUNCTION_CSE
5483 @item NO_FUNCTION_CSE
5484 Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
5485 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
5486
5487 @findex NO_RECURSIVE_FUNCTION_CSE
5488 @item NO_RECURSIVE_FUNCTION_CSE
5489 Define this macro if it is as good or better for a function to call
5490 itself with an explicit address than to call an address kept in a
5491 register.
5492 @end table
5493
5494 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, int @var{code}, int @var{outer_code}, int *@var{total})
5495 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
5496
5497 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
5498 available for examination in @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression
5499 in which it is contained, found in @var{outer_code}. @var{code} is the
5500 expression code---redundant, since it can be obtained with
5501 @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
5502
5503 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
5504 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
5505 instructions.
5506
5507 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
5508 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
5509 necessary.
5510
5511 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
5512 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
5513 @end deftypefn
5514
5515 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address})
5516 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
5517 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
5518 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
5519
5520 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
5521 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
5522 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
5523 all addresses will have equal costs.
5524
5525 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
5526 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
5527 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
5528
5529 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
5530 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
5531 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
5532 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
5533 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
5534 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
5535 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
5536 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
5537
5538 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
5539
5540 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
5541 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
5542 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
5543 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
5544 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
5545 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
5546 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
5547 registers on machines with lots of registers.
5548 @end deftypefn
5549
5550 @node Scheduling
5551 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
5552
5553 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
5554 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
5555 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
5556 them: try the first ones in this list first.
5557
5558 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
5559 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
5560 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
5561 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
5562 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
5563 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
5564 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
5565 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
5566 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
5567 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
5568
5569 For the automaton based pipeline interface, you could define this hook
5570 to return the value of the macro @code{MAX_DFA_ISSUE_RATE}.
5571 @end deftypefn
5572
5573 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{more})
5574 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
5575 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
5576 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
5577 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
5578 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
5579 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
5580 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
5581 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
5582 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
5583 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
5584 was scheduled.
5585 @end deftypefn
5586
5587 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx @var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
5588 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
5589 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
5590 dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
5591 is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
5592 to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
5593 that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
5594 data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
5595 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
5596 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
5597 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
5598 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
5599 @pxref{Automaton pipeline description}.
5600 @end deftypefn
5601
5602 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{priority})
5603 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
5604 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Reduce the priority to
5605 execute @var{insn} earlier, increase the priority to execute @var{insn}
5606 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
5607 scheduling priorities of insns.
5608 @end deftypefn
5609
5610 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
5611 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
5612 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
5613 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
5614 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
5615 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
5616 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
5617 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
5618 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
5619 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
5620 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp}-1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
5621 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
5622 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
5623 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
5624 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
5625 @end deftypefn
5626
5627 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_ready}, @var{clock})
5628 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
5629 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
5630 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
5631 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
5632 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
5633 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
5634 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
5635 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
5636 @end deftypefn
5637
5638 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx @var{head}, rtx @var{tail})
5639 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
5640 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
5641 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
5642 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
5643 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
5644 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
5645 calculated.
5646 @end deftypefn
5647
5648 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
5649 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
5650 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
5651 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
5652 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
5653 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
5654 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
5655 scratch space if it is needed, e.g. by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
5656 @end deftypefn
5657
5658 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
5659 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
5660 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
5661 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
5662 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
5663 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
5664 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
5665 @end deftypefn
5666
5667 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_USE_DFA_PIPELINE_INTERFACE (void)
5668 This hook is called many times during insn scheduling. If the hook
5669 returns nonzero, the automaton based pipeline description is used for
5670 insn scheduling. Otherwise the traditional pipeline description is
5671 used. The default is usage of the traditional pipeline description.
5672
5673 You should also remember that to simplify the insn scheduler sources
5674 an empty traditional pipeline description interface is generated even
5675 if there is no a traditional pipeline description in the @file{.md}
5676 file. The same is true for the automaton based pipeline description.
5677 That means that you should be accurate in defining the hook.
5678 @end deftypefn
5679
5680 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
5681 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
5682 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
5683 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
5684 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
5685 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
5686 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
5687 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
5688 @end deftypefn
5689
5690 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
5691 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
5692 @end deftypefn
5693
5694 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
5695 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
5696 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
5697 simulated processor cycle finishes.
5698 @end deftypefn
5699
5700 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
5701 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
5702 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
5703 @end deftypefn
5704
5705 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
5706 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
5707 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
5708 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
5709 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
5710 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
5711 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
5712 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
5713 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
5714 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
5715 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
5716
5717 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
5718 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
5719 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
5720 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
5721 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
5722 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
5723 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
5724 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
5725 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
5726
5727 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
5728 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
5729 schedules to choose the best one.
5730
5731 The default is no multipass scheduling.
5732 @end deftypefn
5733
5734 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx)
5735
5736 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
5737 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
5738 zero for insn passed as the parameter, the insn will be not chosen to
5739 be issued.
5740
5741 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
5742 @end deftypefn
5743
5744 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *, int, rtx, int, int, int *)
5745
5746 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing insn passed
5747 as the third parameter on given cycle. If the hook returns nonzero,
5748 the insn is not issued on given processors cycle. Instead of that,
5749 the processor cycle is advanced. If the value passed through the last
5750 parameter is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
5751 start as usually. The first parameter passes file for debugging
5752 output. The second one passes the scheduler verbose level of the
5753 debugging output. The forth and the fifth parameter values are
5754 correspondingly processor cycle on which the previous insn has been
5755 issued and the current processor cycle.
5756 @end deftypefn
5757
5758 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_BUBBLES (void)
5759 The @acronym{DFA}-based scheduler could take the insertion of nop
5760 operations for better insn scheduling into account. It can be done
5761 only if the multi-pass insn scheduling works (see hook
5762 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD}).
5763
5764 Let us consider a @acronym{VLIW} processor insn with 3 slots. Each
5765 insn can be placed only in one of the three slots. We have 3 ready
5766 insns @var{A}, @var{B}, and @var{C}. @var{A} and @var{C} can be
5767 placed only in the 1st slot, @var{B} can be placed only in the 3rd
5768 slot. We described the automaton which does not permit empty slot
5769 gaps between insns (usually such description is simpler). Without
5770 this code the scheduler would place each insn in 3 separate
5771 @acronym{VLIW} insns. If the scheduler places a nop insn into the 2nd
5772 slot, it could place the 3 insns into 2 @acronym{VLIW} insns. What is
5773 the nop insn is returned by hook @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_BUBBLE}. Hook
5774 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_BUBBLES} can be used to initialize or
5775 create the nop insns.
5776
5777 You should remember that the scheduler does not insert the nop insns.
5778 It is not wise because of the following optimizations. The scheduler
5779 only considers such possibility to improve the result schedule. The
5780 nop insns should be inserted lately, e.g. on the final phase.
5781 @end deftypefn
5782
5783 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_BUBBLE (int @var{index})
5784 This hook @samp{FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_SCHEDULING} is used to insert
5785 nop operations for better insn scheduling when @acronym{DFA}-based
5786 scheduler makes multipass insn scheduling (see also description of
5787 hook @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_BUBBLES}). This hook
5788 returns a nop insn with given @var{index}. The indexes start with
5789 zero. The hook should return @code{NULL} if there are no more nop
5790 insns with indexes greater than given index.
5791 @end deftypefn
5792
5793 Macros in the following table are generated by the program
5794 @file{genattr} and can be useful for writing the hooks.
5795
5796 @table @code
5797 @findex TRADITIONAL_PIPELINE_INTERFACE
5798 @item TRADITIONAL_PIPELINE_INTERFACE
5799 The macro definition is generated if there is a traditional pipeline
5800 description in @file{.md} file. You should also remember that to
5801 simplify the insn scheduler sources an empty traditional pipeline
5802 description interface is generated even if there is no a traditional
5803 pipeline description in the @file{.md} file. The macro can be used to
5804 distinguish the two types of the traditional interface.
5805
5806 @findex DFA_PIPELINE_INTERFACE
5807 @item DFA_PIPELINE_INTERFACE
5808 The macro definition is generated if there is an automaton pipeline
5809 description in @file{.md} file. You should also remember that to
5810 simplify the insn scheduler sources an empty automaton pipeline
5811 description interface is generated even if there is no an automaton
5812 pipeline description in the @file{.md} file. The macro can be used to
5813 distinguish the two types of the automaton interface.
5814
5815 @findex MAX_DFA_ISSUE_RATE
5816 @item MAX_DFA_ISSUE_RATE
5817 The macro definition is generated in the automaton based pipeline
5818 description interface. Its value is calculated from the automaton
5819 based pipeline description and is equal to maximal number of all insns
5820 described in constructions @samp{define_insn_reservation} which can be
5821 issued on the same processor cycle.
5822
5823 @end table
5824
5825 @node Sections
5826 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
5827 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
5828 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
5829
5830 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
5831 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
5832 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
5833 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
5834 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
5835 of sections.
5836
5837 The compiler must tell the assembler when to switch sections. These
5838 macros control what commands to output to tell the assembler this. You
5839 can also define additional sections.
5840
5841 @table @code
5842 @findex TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5843 @item TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5844 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
5845 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
5846 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
5847
5848 @findex TEXT_SECTION
5849 @item TEXT_SECTION
5850 A C statement that switches to the default section containing instructions.
5851 Normally this is not needed, as simply defining @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
5852 is enough. The MIPS port uses this to sort all functions after all data
5853 declarations.
5854
5855 @findex HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
5856 @item HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
5857 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
5858 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
5859 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
5860
5861 @findex UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
5862 @item UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
5863 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
5864 executed functions in the program.
5865
5866 @findex DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5867 @item DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5868 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
5869 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
5870 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
5871
5872 @findex READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5873 @item READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5874 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
5875 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
5876 data.
5877
5878 @findex READONLY_DATA_SECTION
5879 @item READONLY_DATA_SECTION
5880 A macro naming a function to call to switch to the proper section for
5881 read-only data. The default is to use @code{READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}
5882 if defined, else fall back to @code{text_section}.
5883
5884 The most common definition will be @code{data_section}, if the target
5885 does not have a special read-only data section, and does not put data
5886 in the text section.
5887
5888 @findex SHARED_SECTION_ASM_OP
5889 @item SHARED_SECTION_ASM_OP
5890 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5891 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5892 shared data. If not defined, @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP} will be used.
5893
5894 @findex BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5895 @item BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5896 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5897 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5898 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and neither
5899 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} nor @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are defined,
5900 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
5901 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
5902 used.
5903
5904 @findex SHARED_BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5905 @item SHARED_BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5906 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5907 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5908 uninitialized global shared data. If not defined, and
5909 @code{BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP} is, the latter will be used.
5910
5911 @findex INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5912 @item INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5913 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5914 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5915 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
5916 not exist.
5917
5918 @findex FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
5919 @item FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
5920 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5921 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5922 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
5923 not exist.
5924
5925 @findex CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION
5926 @item CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
5927 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
5928 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
5929 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
5930 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
5931 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
5932 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
5933 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
5934 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
5935 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
5936
5937 @findex FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
5938 @item FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
5939 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
5940 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
5941 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
5942 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
5943
5944 @findex EXTRA_SECTIONS
5945 @findex in_text
5946 @findex in_data
5947 @item EXTRA_SECTIONS
5948 A list of names for sections other than the standard two, which are
5949 @code{in_text} and @code{in_data}. You need not define this macro
5950 on a system with no other sections (that GCC needs to use).
5951
5952 @findex EXTRA_SECTION_FUNCTIONS
5953 @findex text_section
5954 @findex data_section
5955 @item EXTRA_SECTION_FUNCTIONS
5956 One or more functions to be defined in @file{varasm.c}. These
5957 functions should do jobs analogous to those of @code{text_section} and
5958 @code{data_section}, for your additional sections. Do not define this
5959 macro if you do not define @code{EXTRA_SECTIONS}.
5960
5961 @findex JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
5962 @item JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
5963 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
5964 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
5965 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
5966 readonly data section is used.
5967
5968 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
5969 @end table
5970
5971 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
5972 Switches to the appropriate section for output of @var{exp}. You can
5973 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
5974 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
5975 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
5976 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
5977 Select the section by calling @code{data_section} or one of the
5978 alternatives for other sections. @var{align} is the constant alignment
5979 in bits.
5980
5981 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
5982 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
5983 @end deftypefn
5984
5985 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
5986 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
5987 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
5988 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
5989 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
5990
5991 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
5992 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
5993 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
5994 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
5995 @end deftypefn
5996
5997 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
5998 Switches to the appropriate section for output of constant pool entry
5999 @var{x} in @var{mode}. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
6000 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
6001 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. Select the section by calling
6002 @code{readonly_data_section} or one of the alternatives for other
6003 sections. @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
6004
6005 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
6006 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
6007 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6008 @end deftypefn
6009
6010 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
6011 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
6012 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
6013 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
6014
6015 The hook is executed under two circumstances. One is immediately after
6016 the rtl for @var{decl} that represents a variable or a function has been
6017 created and stored in @code{DECL_RTL(@var{decl})}. The value of the rtl
6018 will be a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. The other is
6019 immediately after the rtl for @var{decl} that represents a constant has
6020 been created and stored in @code{TREE_CST_RTL (@var{decl})}. The macro
6021 is called once for each distinct constant in a source file.
6022
6023 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
6024 that @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
6025 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
6026 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
6027 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
6028
6029 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
6030 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record a flag in the
6031 @code{symbol_ref} (such as @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}) or to store a
6032 modified name string in the @code{symbol_ref} (if one bit is not
6033 enough information).
6034 @end deftypefn
6035
6036 @deftypefn {Target Hook} const char *TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *name)
6037 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
6038 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
6039 may have added.
6040 @end deftypefn
6041
6042 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (tree @var{exp})
6043 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
6044 The default version of this hook always returns false.
6045 @end deftypefn
6046
6047 @deftypevar {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
6048 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
6049 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
6050 @end deftypevar
6051
6052 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (tree @var{exp})
6053 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
6054 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
6055 or executable image).
6056
6057 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
6058 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
6059 currently supported object file formats.
6060 @end deftypefn
6061
6062 @deftypevar {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
6063 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
6064 The default value is false.
6065 @end deftypevar
6066
6067
6068 @node PIC
6069 @section Position Independent Code
6070 @cindex position independent code
6071 @cindex PIC
6072
6073 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
6074 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
6075 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the macros
6076 @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} and @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as
6077 well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You must modify the definition of
6078 @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate when the source operand
6079 contains a symbolic address. You may also need to alter the handling of
6080 switch statements so that they use relative addresses.
6081 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
6082 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
6083
6084 @table @code
6085 @findex PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
6086 @item PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
6087 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
6088 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
6089 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
6090 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
6091 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
6092 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
6093 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
6094 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
6095
6096 @findex PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
6097 @item PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
6098 Define this macro if the register defined by
6099 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. Do not define
6100 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
6101
6102 @findex FINALIZE_PIC
6103 @item FINALIZE_PIC
6104 By generating position-independent code, when two different programs (A
6105 and B) share a common library (libC.a), the text of the library can be
6106 shared whether or not the library is linked at the same address for both
6107 programs. In some of these environments, position-independent code
6108 requires not only the use of different addressing modes, but also
6109 special code to enable the use of these addressing modes.
6110
6111 The @code{FINALIZE_PIC} macro serves as a hook to emit these special
6112 codes once the function is being compiled into assembly code, but not
6113 before. (It is not done before, because in the case of compiling an
6114 inline function, it would lead to multiple PIC prologues being
6115 included in functions which used inline functions and were compiled to
6116 assembly language.)
6117
6118 @findex LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P
6119 @item LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
6120 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
6121 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
6122 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
6123 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
6124 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
6125 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
6126 position independent code.
6127 @end table
6128
6129 @node Assembler Format
6130 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
6131
6132 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
6133 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
6134 instructions do.
6135
6136 @menu
6137 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
6138 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
6139 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
6140 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
6141 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
6142 and termination routines.
6143 * Macros for Initialization::
6144 Specific macros that control the handling of
6145 initialization and termination routines.
6146 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
6147 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
6148 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
6149 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
6150 @end menu
6151
6152 @node File Framework
6153 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
6154 @cindex assembler format
6155 @cindex output of assembler code
6156
6157 @c prevent bad page break with this line
6158 This describes the overall framework of an assembler file.
6159
6160 @table @code
6161 @findex ASM_FILE_START
6162 @item ASM_FILE_START (@var{stream})
6163 A C expression which outputs to the stdio stream @var{stream}
6164 some appropriate text to go at the start of an assembler file.
6165
6166 Normally this macro is defined to output a line containing
6167 @samp{#NO_APP}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
6168 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it can save time by not
6169 checking for certain assembler constructs.
6170
6171 On systems that use SDB, it is necessary to output certain commands;
6172 see @file{attasm.h}.
6173
6174 @findex ASM_FILE_END
6175 @item ASM_FILE_END (@var{stream})
6176 A C expression which outputs to the stdio stream @var{stream}
6177 some appropriate text to go at the end of an assembler file.
6178
6179 If this macro is not defined, the default is to output nothing
6180 special at the end of the file. Most systems don't require any
6181 definition.
6182
6183 On systems that use SDB, it is necessary to output certain commands;
6184 see @file{attasm.h}.
6185
6186 @findex ASM_COMMENT_START
6187 @item ASM_COMMENT_START
6188 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
6189 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
6190 the end of the line.
6191
6192 @findex ASM_APP_ON
6193 @item ASM_APP_ON
6194 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
6195 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
6196 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
6197 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
6198 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
6199
6200 @findex ASM_APP_OFF
6201 @item ASM_APP_OFF
6202 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
6203 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
6204 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
6205 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
6206
6207 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
6208 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6209 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
6210 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
6211 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
6212
6213 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
6214 for the file format in use is appropriate.
6215
6216 @findex OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING
6217 @item OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
6218 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
6219 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
6220 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
6221 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
6222 of the filename using this macro.
6223
6224 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE
6225 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
6226 A C statement to output DBX or SDB debugging information before code
6227 for line number @var{line} of the current source file to the
6228 stdio stream @var{stream}.
6229
6230 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of debugging
6231 information for the debugger in use is appropriate.
6232
6233 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT
6234 @item ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
6235 A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
6236 @samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
6237 macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
6238
6239 @findex OBJC_PROLOGUE
6240 @item OBJC_PROLOGUE
6241 A C statement to output any assembler statements which are required to
6242 precede any Objective-C object definitions or message sending. The
6243 statement is executed only when compiling an Objective-C program.
6244 @end table
6245
6246 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, unsigned int @var{align})
6247 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
6248 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
6249 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{align}
6250 is nonzero, it contains an alignment in bytes to be used for the section,
6251 otherwise some target default should be used. Only targets that must
6252 specify an alignment within the section directive need pay attention to
6253 @var{align} -- we will still use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}.
6254 @end deftypefn
6255
6256 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
6257 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
6258 @end deftypefn
6259
6260 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
6261 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
6262 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
6263 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
6264 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
6265
6266 The default version if this function handles choosing code vs data,
6267 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
6268 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
6269 set via @code{__attribute__}.
6270 @end deftypefn
6271
6272 @need 2000
6273 @node Data Output
6274 @subsection Output of Data
6275
6276
6277 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
6278 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
6279 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
6280 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
6281 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
6282 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
6283 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
6284 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
6285 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
6286 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
6287 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
6288 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
6289 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
6290 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
6291
6292 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
6293 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
6294 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
6295 @end deftypevr
6296
6297 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
6298 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
6299 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
6300 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
6301 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
6302 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
6303 split the object into smaller parts.
6304
6305 The default implementation of this hook will use the
6306 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
6307 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
6308 @end deftypefn
6309
6310 @table @code
6311 @findex OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
6312 @item OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
6313 A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
6314 @code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
6315 @var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to
6316 allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
6317
6318 If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
6319 @code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed. If it
6320 prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
6321 @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
6322
6323 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII
6324 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
6325 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
6326 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
6327 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
6328 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
6329
6330 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
6331 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
6332 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
6333
6334 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC
6335 @item ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
6336 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
6337 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
6338 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
6339
6340 @findex CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
6341 @item CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
6342 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
6343 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
6344 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
6345 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
6346 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
6347 pool before the function.
6348
6349 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE
6350 @item ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
6351 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
6352 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
6353 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
6354 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
6355 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
6356 immediately after this call.
6357
6358 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
6359 not be defined.
6360
6361 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY
6362 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
6363 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
6364 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
6365 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
6366
6367 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
6368 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
6369 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
6370 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
6371 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
6372 alignment.
6373
6374 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
6375 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
6376 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
6377 Here is how to do this:
6378
6379 @example
6380 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
6381 @end example
6382
6383 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
6384 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
6385 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
6386
6387 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
6388
6389 @findex CONSTANT_AFTER_FUNCTION_P
6390 @item CONSTANT_AFTER_FUNCTION_P (@var{exp})
6391 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if the constant
6392 @var{exp}, of type @code{tree}, should be output after the code for a
6393 function. The compiler will normally output all constants before the
6394 function; you need not define this macro if this is OK@.
6395
6396 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE
6397 @item ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
6398 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
6399 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
6400 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
6401 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
6402 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
6403
6404 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
6405 define this macro.
6406
6407 @findex IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR
6408 @item IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C})
6409 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
6410 used as a logical line separator by the assembler.
6411
6412 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
6413 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
6414 @end table
6415
6416 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
6417 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
6418 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
6419 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
6420 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
6421 @end deftypevr
6422
6423 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
6424 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
6425
6426 @table @code
6427 @item REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
6428 @itemx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
6429 @itemx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
6430 @findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE
6431 @findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE
6432 @findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE
6433 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the target's
6434 floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in the variable
6435 @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE}, this variable should
6436 be a simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
6437 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined by
6438 the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of it
6439 go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds 32
6440 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits on the
6441 host machine.
6442
6443 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
6444 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
6445 machine's memory.
6446 @end table
6447
6448 @node Uninitialized Data
6449 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
6450
6451 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
6452 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
6453
6454 @table @code
6455 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON
6456 @item ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6457 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6458 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
6459 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
6460 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6461
6462 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6463 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6464 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
6465
6466 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
6467 common global variables are output.
6468
6469 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON
6470 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6471 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
6472 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
6473 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
6474 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
6475 as the number of bits.
6476
6477 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON
6478 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6479 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
6480 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
6481 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
6482 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
6483 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
6484 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
6485
6486 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_COMMON
6487 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6488 If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, except that it
6489 is used when @var{name} is shared. If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}
6490 will be used.
6491
6492 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_BSS
6493 @item ASM_OUTPUT_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6494 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6495 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
6496 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
6497 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6498
6499 Try to use function @code{asm_output_bss} defined in @file{varasm.c} when
6500 defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
6501 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
6502 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
6503 the name, and a newline.
6504
6505 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized global
6506 variables are output. This macro exists to properly support languages like
6507 C++ which do not have @code{common} data. However, this macro currently
6508 is not defined for all targets. If this macro and
6509 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are not defined then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}
6510 or @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} or
6511 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON} is used.
6512
6513 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS
6514 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6515 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} except takes the required alignment as a
6516 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
6517 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, and gives you more flexibility in
6518 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
6519 as the number of bits.
6520
6521 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
6522 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.
6523
6524 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_BSS
6525 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6526 If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, except that it
6527 is used when @var{name} is shared. If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}
6528 will be used.
6529
6530 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL
6531 @item ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6532 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6533 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
6534 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
6535 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6536
6537 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6538 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6539 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
6540
6541 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
6542 static variables are output.
6543
6544 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL
6545 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6546 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
6547 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
6548 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
6549 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
6550 as the number of bits.
6551
6552 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL
6553 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6554 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
6555 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
6556 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
6557 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
6558 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
6559 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
6560
6561 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_LOCAL
6562 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6563 If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, except that it
6564 is used when @var{name} is shared. If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}
6565 will be used.
6566 @end table
6567
6568 @node Label Output
6569 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
6570
6571 @c prevent bad page break with this line
6572 This is about outputting labels.
6573
6574 @table @code
6575 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL
6576 @findex assemble_name
6577 @item ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6578 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6579 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
6580 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6581 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6582 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
6583 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
6584
6585 @findex SIZE_ASM_OP
6586 @item SIZE_ASM_OP
6587 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
6588 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
6589 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
6590 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
6591
6592 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
6593 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
6594 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
6595 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
6596 define this macro.
6597
6598 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE
6599 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
6600 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6601 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
6602 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
6603 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
6604 provided.
6605
6606 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE
6607 @item ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6608 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6609 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
6610 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
6611 address.
6612
6613 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
6614 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
6615 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
6616 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
6617 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
6618 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
6619
6620 @findex TYPE_ASM_OP
6621 @item TYPE_ASM_OP
6622 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
6623 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
6624 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
6625 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
6626
6627 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
6628 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
6629 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
6630 types at all, do not define this macro.
6631
6632 @findex TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
6633 @item TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
6634 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
6635 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
6636 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
6637 the default is not to define this macro.
6638
6639 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
6640 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
6641 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
6642 types at all, do not define this macro.
6643
6644 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE
6645 @item ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
6646 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6647 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
6648 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
6649 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
6650 you should not count on this.
6651
6652 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
6653 definition of this macro is provided.
6654
6655 @findex ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME
6656 @item ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6657 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6658 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
6659 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
6660 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
6661 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
6662 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
6663
6664 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
6665 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
6666
6667 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
6668 of this macro.
6669
6670 @findex ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE
6671 @item ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6672 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6673 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
6674 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
6675 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
6676 representing the function.
6677
6678 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
6679
6680 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
6681 of this macro.
6682
6683 @findex ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME
6684 @item ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6685 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6686 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
6687 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
6688 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
6689 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
6690
6691 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
6692 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
6693
6694 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
6695 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
6696
6697 @findex ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL
6698 @item ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
6699 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6700 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
6701 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
6702
6703 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
6704 nothing.
6705
6706 @findex ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT
6707 @item ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
6708 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
6709 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
6710 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
6711 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
6712 something about the size of the object.
6713
6714 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
6715 nothing.
6716
6717 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
6718 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
6719 @end table
6720
6721 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
6722 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
6723 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
6724 that is, available for reference from other files.
6725
6726 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
6727 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
6728 @end deftypefn
6729
6730 @table @code
6731 @findex ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL
6732 @item ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6733 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6734 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
6735 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
6736 no other definition is available. Use the expression
6737 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
6738 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
6739 for making that name weak, and a newline.
6740
6741 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
6742 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
6743 macro.
6744
6745 @findex ASM_WEAKEN_DECL
6746 @item ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
6747 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
6748 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
6749 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
6750 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
6751 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
6752 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
6753 to make @var{name} weak.
6754
6755 @findex SUPPORTS_WEAK
6756 @item SUPPORTS_WEAK
6757 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
6758
6759 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
6760 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
6761 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is
6762 @samp{0}. Define this macro if you want to control weak symbol support
6763 with a compiler flag such as @option{-melf}.
6764
6765 @findex MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
6766 @item MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY
6767 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
6768 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
6769 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
6770 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
6771 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
6772 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
6773
6774 @findex SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
6775 @item SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
6776 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
6777 semantics.
6778
6779 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
6780 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
6781 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
6782 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
6783 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
6784 be emitted as one-only.
6785
6786 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{visibility})
6787 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
6788 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
6789 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
6790 @end deftypefn
6791
6792 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL
6793 @item ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
6794 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6795 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
6796 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
6797 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
6798 declaration.
6799
6800 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
6801 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
6802
6803 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
6804 @item ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (@var{stream}, @var{symref})
6805 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output on @var{stream} an assembler
6806 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
6807 library function is given by @var{symref}, which has type @code{rtx} and
6808 is a @code{symbol_ref}.
6809
6810 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
6811 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
6812
6813 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF
6814 @item ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6815 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6816 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
6817 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
6818 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
6819 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
6820
6821 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF
6822 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
6823 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
6824 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
6825 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
6826 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
6827 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
6828
6829 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF
6830 @item ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
6831 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
6832 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
6833 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
6834 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
6835 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
6836 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
6837 being taken.
6838 @end table
6839
6840 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
6841 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
6842 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
6843
6844 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
6845 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
6846 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
6847
6848 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
6849 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
6850 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
6851 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
6852 convention your system uses, and follow it.
6853
6854 The default version of this function utilizes ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL.
6855
6856 @end deftypefn
6857
6858 @table @code
6859 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL
6860 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6861 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
6862 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
6863 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
6864 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
6865 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
6866 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
6867 bundles.
6868
6869 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
6870 used.
6871
6872 @findex ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL
6873 @item ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6874 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
6875 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
6876
6877 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
6878 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
6879 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
6880
6881 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
6882 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
6883 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
6884 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
6885 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
6886 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
6887 you should know what it does on your machine.)
6888
6889 @findex ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME
6890 @item ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
6891 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
6892 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
6893 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
6894 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
6895
6896 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
6897 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
6898 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
6899 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
6900 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
6901 internal static variables in different scopes.
6902
6903 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
6904 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
6905 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
6906 between the name and the number will suffice.
6907
6908 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
6909 which is correct for most systems.
6910
6911 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEF
6912 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
6913 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6914 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
6915
6916 @findex SET_ASM_OP
6917 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
6918 correct for most systems.
6919
6920 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS
6921 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
6922 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6923 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
6924 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
6925 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
6926 the tree nodes are available.
6927
6928 @findex SET_ASM_OP
6929 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
6930 correct for most systems.
6931
6932 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS
6933 @item ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
6934 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6935 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
6936 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
6937 an undefined weak symbol.
6938
6939 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
6940 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
6941
6942 @findex OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL
6943 @item OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
6944 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
6945 Objective-C methods.
6946
6947 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
6948 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
6949 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
6950 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
6951
6952 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
6953 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
6954 systems define other ways of computing names.
6955
6956 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
6957 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
6958 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
6959 50 characters extra.
6960
6961 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
6962 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
6963 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
6964 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
6965
6966 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
6967 macro to provide more human-readable names.
6968
6969 @findex ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE
6970 @item ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6971 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6972 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
6973 Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
6974 linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
6975
6976 @findex ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE
6977 @item ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6978 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6979 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
6980 unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
6981 whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
6982 @end table
6983
6984 @node Initialization
6985 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
6986 @cindex initialization routines
6987 @cindex termination routines
6988 @cindex constructors, output of
6989 @cindex destructors, output of
6990
6991 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
6992 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
6993 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
6994 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
6995 @code{main} is called.
6996
6997 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
6998 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
6999 terminates.
7000
7001 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
7002 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
7003 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
7004 system, you need to specify how to do this.
7005
7006 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
7007 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
7008 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
7009
7010 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
7011 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
7012 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
7013 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
7014 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
7015
7016 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
7017 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
7018 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
7019 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
7020 pointer containing zero.
7021
7022 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
7023 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
7024 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
7025 list; destructors in forward order.
7026
7027 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
7028 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
7029 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
7030 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
7031 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
7032 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
7033 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
7034 Termination functions are handled similarly.
7035
7036 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
7037 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
7038 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
7039 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
7040 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
7041
7042 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
7043 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
7044 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
7045 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
7046 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
7047
7048 @example
7049 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
7050 @end example
7051
7052 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
7053 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
7054 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
7055 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
7056 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
7057
7058 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
7059 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
7060 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
7061 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
7062 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
7063 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
7064
7065 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
7066 macro properly.
7067
7068 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
7069 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
7070 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
7071 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
7072 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
7073 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
7074
7075 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
7076 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
7077 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
7078 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
7079 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
7080 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
7081 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
7082 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
7083 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
7084 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
7085 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
7086 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
7087 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
7088 the initialization process.
7089
7090 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
7091 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
7092 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
7093 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
7094 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
7095 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
7096 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
7097 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
7098 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
7099 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
7100 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
7101
7102 @ifinfo
7103 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
7104 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
7105 @end ifinfo
7106
7107 @node Macros for Initialization
7108 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
7109
7110 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
7111 and termination functions:
7112
7113 @table @code
7114 @findex INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7115 @item INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7116 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
7117 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
7118 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
7119 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
7120 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
7121 run the initialization functions.
7122
7123 @item HAS_INIT_SECTION
7124 @findex HAS_INIT_SECTION
7125 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
7126 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
7127 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
7128 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7129
7130 @item LD_INIT_SWITCH
7131 @findex LD_INIT_SWITCH
7132 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
7133 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
7134
7135 @item LD_FINI_SWITCH
7136 @findex LD_FINI_SWITCH
7137 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
7138 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
7139
7140 @item COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
7141 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
7142 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
7143 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
7144 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
7145 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
7146
7147 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
7148 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
7149 exception tables embedded in the code.
7150
7151 @item COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
7152 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
7153 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
7154 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
7155 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
7156 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
7157
7158 @item INVOKE__main
7159 @findex INVOKE__main
7160 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
7161 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
7162 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
7163 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
7164
7165 @item SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
7166 @findex SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
7167 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
7168 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
7169 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
7170 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
7171 @end table
7172
7173 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
7174 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
7175 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
7176 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
7177 @end deftypefn
7178
7179 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
7180 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
7181 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
7182
7183 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
7184 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
7185 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
7186 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
7187
7188 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
7189 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
7190 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
7191 is not defined.
7192 @end deftypefn
7193
7194 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
7195 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
7196 functions rather than initialization functions.
7197 @end deftypefn
7198
7199 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
7200 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
7201
7202 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
7203 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
7204 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
7205
7206 On certain kinds of systems, you can define these macros to make
7207 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
7208
7209 @table @code
7210 @findex OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
7211 @item OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
7212 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
7213 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
7214 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
7215
7216 @findex OBJECT_FORMAT_ROSE
7217 @item OBJECT_FORMAT_ROSE
7218 Define this macro if the system uses ROSE format object files, so that
7219 @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan object files directly
7220 for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
7221
7222 These macros are effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
7223 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
7224
7225 @findex REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
7226 @item REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
7227 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
7228 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
7229 @command{nm}.
7230
7231 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
7232 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
7233 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
7234 termination functions in shared libraries:
7235
7236 @findex LDD_SUFFIX
7237 @item LDD_SUFFIX
7238 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
7239 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{"ldd"} under SunOS 4.
7240
7241 @findex PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT
7242 @item PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
7243 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
7244 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
7245 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
7246 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
7247 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
7248 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
7249 @end table
7250
7251 @node Instruction Output
7252 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
7253
7254 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7255 This describes assembler instruction output.
7256
7257 @table @code
7258 @findex REGISTER_NAMES
7259 @item REGISTER_NAMES
7260 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
7261 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
7262 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
7263
7264 @findex ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
7265 @item ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
7266 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
7267 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
7268 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
7269 to registers using alternate names.
7270
7271 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE
7272 @item ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
7273 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
7274 requires different names for the machine instructions.
7275
7276 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
7277 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
7278 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
7279 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
7280 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
7281 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
7282 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
7283 so that it will not be output twice.
7284
7285 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
7286 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
7287 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
7288 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
7289 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
7290
7291 @findex recog_data.operand
7292 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
7293 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
7294
7295 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
7296 in the usual way.
7297
7298 @findex FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN
7299 @item FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
7300 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
7301 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
7302 they will be output differently.
7303
7304 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
7305 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
7306 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
7307 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
7308 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
7309 by changing the contents of the vector.
7310
7311 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
7312 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
7313 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
7314 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
7315 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
7316 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
7317
7318 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
7319
7320 @findex FINAL_PRESCAN_LABEL
7321 @item FINAL_PRESCAN_LABEL
7322 If defined, @code{FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN} will be called on each
7323 @code{CODE_LABEL}. In that case, @var{opvec} will be a null pointer and
7324 @var{noperands} will be zero.
7325
7326 @findex PRINT_OPERAND
7327 @item PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
7328 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
7329 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
7330 RTL expression.
7331
7332 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
7333 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
7334 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
7335 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
7336 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
7337 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
7338 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
7339
7340 @findex reg_names
7341 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
7342 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
7343 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
7344 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
7345
7346 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
7347 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
7348 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
7349 @var{code}.
7350
7351 @findex PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P
7352 @item PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
7353 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
7354 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
7355 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
7356 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
7357 in this way.
7358
7359 @findex PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS
7360 @item PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
7361 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
7362 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
7363 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
7364
7365 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
7366 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
7367 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
7368 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
7369 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler Format}.
7370
7371 @findex DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND
7372 @findex dbr_sequence_length
7373 @item DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND(@var{file})
7374 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
7375 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
7376 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
7377 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
7378 or whatever.
7379
7380 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
7381 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
7382 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
7383
7384 @findex final_sequence
7385 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
7386 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
7387 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
7388 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
7389 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
7390 being output.
7391
7392 @findex REGISTER_PREFIX
7393 @findex LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
7394 @findex USER_LABEL_PREFIX
7395 @findex IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
7396 @findex asm_fprintf
7397 @item REGISTER_PREFIX
7398 @itemx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
7399 @itemx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
7400 @itemx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
7401 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
7402 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
7403 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
7404 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
7405 files can define these macros differently.
7406
7407 @item ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS(@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
7408 @findex ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS
7409 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
7410 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
7411 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
7412 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
7413 statements. Note that upper case letters are reserved for future
7414 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
7415 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
7416 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
7417 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
7418 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
7419
7420 @findex ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
7421 @item ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
7422 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
7423 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
7424 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
7425 first variant.
7426
7427 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
7428 @smallexample
7429 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
7430 @end smallexample
7431 @noindent
7432 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
7433 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
7434 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
7435 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
7436 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
7437 alternatives within the braces than the value of
7438 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
7439
7440 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
7441 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
7442 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
7443
7444 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
7445 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
7446 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
7447 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
7448 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
7449 opcodes or operand order.
7450
7451 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH
7452 @item ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
7453 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
7454 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
7455 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
7456 profiling.
7457
7458 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP
7459 @item ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
7460 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
7461 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
7462 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
7463 profiling.
7464 @end table
7465
7466 @node Dispatch Tables
7467 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
7468
7469 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7470 This concerns dispatch tables.
7471
7472 @table @code
7473 @cindex dispatch table
7474 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT
7475 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
7476 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7477 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
7478 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
7479 definitions of these labels are output using
7480 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
7481 way here. For example,
7482
7483 @example
7484 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
7485 @var{value}, @var{rel})
7486 @end example
7487
7488 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
7489 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
7490 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
7491 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
7492 mode and flags can be read.
7493
7494 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT
7495 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
7496 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
7497 in a dispatch table are absolute.
7498
7499 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
7500 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
7501 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
7502 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
7503 For example,
7504
7505 @example
7506 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
7507 @end example
7508
7509 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL
7510 @item ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
7511 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
7512 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
7513 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
7514 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
7515 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
7516
7517 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
7518 for the table.
7519
7520 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
7521 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
7522
7523 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END
7524 @item ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
7525 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
7526 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
7527 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
7528 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
7529 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
7530 of the preceding label.
7531
7532 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
7533 the jump-table.
7534 @end table
7535
7536 @node Exception Region Output
7537 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
7538
7539 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7540
7541 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
7542 region.
7543
7544 @table @code
7545 @findex EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
7546 @item EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
7547 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
7548 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
7549 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
7550 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
7551
7552 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
7553 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
7554
7555 @findex EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
7556 @item EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
7557 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
7558 data section even though the target supports named sections. This
7559 might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
7560 collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
7561
7562 Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
7563 also defined.
7564
7565 @findex MASK_RETURN_ADDR
7566 @item MASK_RETURN_ADDR
7567 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
7568 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
7569
7570 @findex DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
7571 @item DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
7572 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
7573 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
7574 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
7575 @samp{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @samp{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
7576 or @samp{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of
7577 1.
7578
7579 If this macro is defined to 1, the DWARF 2 unwinder will be the default
7580 exception handling mechanism; otherwise, @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} will be used by
7581 default.
7582
7583 If this macro is defined to anything, the DWARF 2 unwinder will be used
7584 instead of inline unwinders and @code{__unwind_function} in the non-@code{setjmp} case.
7585
7586 @findex DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
7587 @item DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
7588 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
7589 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
7590 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
7591 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
7592 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
7593 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
7594
7595 @end table
7596
7597 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXCEPTION_SECTION ()
7598 If defined, a function that switches to the section in which the main
7599 exception table is to be placed (@pxref{Sections}). The default is a
7600 function that switches to a section named @code{.gcc_except_table} on
7601 machines that support named sections via
7602 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}, otherwise if @option{-fpic} or
7603 @option{-fPIC} is in effect, the @code{data_section}, otherwise the
7604 @code{readonly_data_section}.
7605 @end deftypefn
7606
7607 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EH_FRAME_SECTION ()
7608 If defined, a function that switches to the section in which the DWARF 2
7609 frame unwind information to be placed (@pxref{Sections}). The default
7610 is a function that outputs a standard GAS section directive, if
7611 @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, or else a data section
7612 directive followed by a synthetic label.
7613 @end deftypefn
7614
7615 @deftypevar {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
7616 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
7617 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
7618 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
7619 true otherwise.
7620 @end deftypevar
7621
7622 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
7623 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
7624 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
7625 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
7626 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
7627 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
7628 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
7629 @end deftypefn
7630
7631 @node Alignment Output
7632 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
7633
7634 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7635 This describes commands for alignment.
7636
7637 @table @code
7638 @findex JUMP_ALIGN
7639 @item JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
7640 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
7641 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
7642
7643 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
7644 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
7645 define the macro.
7646
7647 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
7648 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
7649 @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
7650 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
7651
7652 @findex LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER
7653 @item LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
7654 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
7655 a @code{BARRIER}.
7656
7657 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
7658 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
7659 define the macro.
7660
7661 @findex LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
7662 @item LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
7663 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying
7664 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
7665 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
7666
7667 @findex LOOP_ALIGN
7668 @item LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
7669 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
7670 a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
7671
7672 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
7673 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
7674 define the macro.
7675
7676 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
7677 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
7678 @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
7679 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
7680
7681 @findex LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7682 @item LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7683 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN}.
7684 This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
7685
7686 @findex LABEL_ALIGN
7687 @item LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
7688 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
7689 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
7690 the maximum of the specified values is used.
7691
7692 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
7693 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
7694 @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
7695 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
7696
7697 @findex LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7698 @item LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7699 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}.
7700 This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
7701
7702 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP
7703 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
7704 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7705 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
7706 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
7707 expression of type @code{int}.
7708
7709 @findex ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
7710 @item ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
7711 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
7712 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
7713 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
7714 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
7715 section.
7716
7717 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN
7718 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
7719 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7720 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
7721 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
7722
7723 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP
7724 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
7725 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
7726 for padding, if necessary.
7727
7728 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN
7729 @item ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
7730 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7731 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
7732 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
7733 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
7734 a C expression of type @code{int}.
7735 @end table
7736
7737 @need 3000
7738 @node Debugging Info
7739 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
7740
7741 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7742 This describes how to specify debugging information.
7743
7744 @menu
7745 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
7746 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
7747 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
7748 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
7749 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
7750 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
7751 @end menu
7752
7753 @node All Debuggers
7754 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
7755
7756 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7757 These macros affect all debugging formats.
7758
7759 @table @code
7760 @findex DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER
7761 @item DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
7762 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
7763 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
7764 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
7765 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
7766 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
7767 compiler and another for DBX@.
7768
7769 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
7770 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
7771 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
7772 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
7773 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
7774
7775 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
7776 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
7777 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
7778
7779 @findex DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET
7780 @item DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
7781 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
7782 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
7783 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
7784 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
7785 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
7786 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
7787 @option{-g} options is used.
7788
7789 @findex DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET
7790 @item DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
7791 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
7792 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
7793 @var{offset}.
7794
7795 @findex PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
7796 @item PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
7797 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
7798 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
7799 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
7800 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
7801 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
7802 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
7803
7804 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
7805 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
7806 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined and
7807 @code{LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2} is not defined, GCC uses the
7808 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
7809 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
7810
7811 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
7812 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
7813 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-1}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff},
7814 or @option{-gvms}.
7815 @end table
7816
7817 @node DBX Options
7818 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
7819
7820 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7821 These are specific options for DBX output.
7822
7823 @table @code
7824 @findex DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
7825 @item DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
7826 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
7827 in response to the @option{-g} option.
7828
7829 @findex XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7830 @item XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7831 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
7832 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
7833
7834 @findex DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
7835 @item DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
7836 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
7837 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
7838 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
7839 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
7840 if there is any occasion to.
7841
7842 @findex DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
7843 @item DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
7844 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
7845 in the text section.
7846
7847 @findex ASM_STABS_OP
7848 @item ASM_STABS_OP
7849 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
7850 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
7851 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
7852 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
7853
7854 @findex ASM_STABD_OP
7855 @item ASM_STABD_OP
7856 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
7857 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
7858 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
7859 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
7860 information format.
7861
7862 @findex ASM_STABN_OP
7863 @item ASM_STABN_OP
7864 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
7865 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
7866 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
7867 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
7868
7869 @findex DBX_NO_XREFS
7870 @item DBX_NO_XREFS
7871 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
7872 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
7873 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
7874 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
7875
7876 @findex DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
7877 @item DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
7878 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
7879 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
7880 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
7881 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
7882 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
7883 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
7884 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
7885
7886 @findex DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
7887 @item DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
7888 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
7889 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
7890 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
7891 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
7892 if backslash is correct for your system.
7893
7894 @findex DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
7895 @item DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
7896 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
7897 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
7898 variable.
7899
7900 @findex DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
7901 @item DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
7902 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7903 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
7904
7905 @findex DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
7906 @item DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
7907 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7908 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
7909 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
7910
7911 @findex DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
7912 @item DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
7913 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7914 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
7915 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
7916
7917 @findex DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
7918 @item DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
7919 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
7920 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
7921 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
7922
7923 @findex DBX_MEMPARM_STABS_LETTER
7924 @item DBX_MEMPARM_STABS_LETTER
7925 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a stack
7926 parameter. The default is @code{'p'}.
7927
7928 @findex DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
7929 @item DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
7930 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
7931 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
7932 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
7933 code.
7934
7935 @findex DBX_LBRAC_FIRST
7936 @item DBX_LBRAC_FIRST
7937 Define this macro if the @code{N_LBRAC} symbol for a block should
7938 precede the debugging information for variables and functions defined in
7939 that block. Normally, in DBX format, the @code{N_LBRAC} symbol comes
7940 first.
7941
7942 @findex DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
7943 @item DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
7944 Define this macro if the value of a symbol describing the scope of a
7945 block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be relative to the start
7946 of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
7947
7948 @findex DBX_USE_BINCL
7949 @item DBX_USE_BINCL
7950 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
7951 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
7952 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
7953 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
7954 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
7955 number for a type number.
7956 @end table
7957
7958 @node DBX Hooks
7959 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
7960
7961 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7962 These are hooks for DBX format.
7963
7964 @table @code
7965 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC
7966 @item DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7967 Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
7968 information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
7969 argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
7970 @code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
7971
7972 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC
7973 @item DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7974 Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
7975
7976 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN
7977 @item DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
7978 Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
7979 output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
7980
7981 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_ENUM
7982 @item DBX_OUTPUT_ENUM (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7983 Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
7984 output an enumeration type. The definition should be a C statement
7985 (sans semicolon) to output the appropriate information to @var{stream}
7986 for the type @var{type}.
7987
7988 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_END
7989 @item DBX_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_END (@var{stream}, @var{function})
7990 Define this macro if the target machine requires special output at the
7991 end of the debugging information for a function. The definition should
7992 be a C statement (sans semicolon) to output the appropriate information
7993 to @var{stream}. @var{function} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} node for
7994 the function.
7995
7996 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES
7997 @item DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES (@var{syms})
7998 Define this macro if you need to control the order of output of the
7999 standard data types at the beginning of compilation. The argument
8000 @var{syms} is a @code{tree} which is a chain of all the predefined
8001 global symbols, including names of data types.
8002
8003 Normally, DBX output starts with definitions of the types for integers
8004 and characters, followed by all the other predefined types of the
8005 particular language in no particular order.
8006
8007 On some machines, it is necessary to output different particular types
8008 first. To do this, define @code{DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES} to output
8009 those symbols in the necessary order. Any predefined types that you
8010 don't explicitly output will be output afterward in no particular order.
8011
8012 Be careful not to define this macro so that it works only for C@. There
8013 are no global variables to access most of the built-in types, because
8014 another language may have another set of types. The way to output a
8015 particular type is to look through @var{syms} to see if you can find it.
8016 Here is an example:
8017
8018 @smallexample
8019 @{
8020 tree decl;
8021 for (decl = syms; decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
8022 if (!strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (decl)),
8023 "long int"))
8024 dbxout_symbol (decl);
8025 @dots{}
8026 @}
8027 @end smallexample
8028
8029 @noindent
8030 This does nothing if the expected type does not exist.
8031
8032 See the function @code{init_decl_processing} in @file{c-decl.c} to find
8033 the names to use for all the built-in C types.
8034
8035 Here is another way of finding a particular type:
8036
8037 @c this is still overfull. --mew 10feb93
8038 @smallexample
8039 @{
8040 tree decl;
8041 for (decl = syms; decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
8042 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL
8043 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
8044 == INTEGER_CST)
8045 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == 16
8046 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
8047 @group
8048 /* @r{This must be @code{unsigned short}.} */
8049 dbxout_symbol (decl);
8050 @dots{}
8051 @}
8052 @end group
8053 @end smallexample
8054
8055 @findex NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
8056 @item NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
8057 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
8058 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
8059 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
8060 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
8061
8062 @end table
8063
8064 @node File Names and DBX
8065 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
8066
8067 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8068 This describes file names in DBX format.
8069
8070 @table @code
8071 @findex DBX_WORKING_DIRECTORY
8072 @item DBX_WORKING_DIRECTORY
8073 Define this if DBX wants to have the current directory recorded in each
8074 object file.
8075
8076 Note that the working directory is always recorded if GDB extensions are
8077 enabled.
8078
8079 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME
8080 @item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8081 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
8082 @var{stream} which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
8083 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
8084 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
8085
8086 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
8087 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
8088
8089 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
8090 @item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8091 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
8092 @var{stream} which indicates that the current directory during
8093 compilation is named @var{name}.
8094
8095 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
8096 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
8097
8098 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
8099 @item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8100 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
8101 compilation of the main source file @var{name}.
8102
8103 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
8104 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
8105
8106 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
8107 @item DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8108 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
8109 @var{stream} which indicates that file @var{name} is the current source
8110 file. This output is generated each time input shifts to a different
8111 source file as a result of @samp{#include}, the end of an included file,
8112 or a @samp{#line} command.
8113
8114 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
8115 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
8116 @end table
8117
8118 @need 2000
8119 @node SDB and DWARF
8120 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
8121
8122 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8123 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
8124
8125 @table @code
8126 @findex SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
8127 @item SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
8128 Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
8129 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
8130
8131 @findex DWARF_DEBUGGING_INFO
8132 @item DWARF_DEBUGGING_INFO
8133 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf format debugging output
8134 in response to the @option{-g} option.
8135
8136 @findex DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
8137 @item DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
8138 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
8139 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
8140
8141 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
8142 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
8143 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
8144 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
8145 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
8146
8147 @findex DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
8148 @item DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
8149 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
8150 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}
8151 (@pxref{Exception Region Output} is nonzero, GCC will output this
8152 information not matter how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
8153
8154 @findex LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2
8155 @item LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2
8156 Define this macro if the linker does not work with Dwarf version 2.
8157 Normally, if the user specifies only @option{-ggdb} GCC will use Dwarf
8158 version 2 if available; this macro disables this. See the description
8159 of the @code{PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE} macro for more details.
8160
8161 @findex DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
8162 @item DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
8163 By default, the Dwarf 2 debugging information generator will generate a
8164 label to mark the beginning of the text section. If it is better simply
8165 to use the name of the text section itself, rather than an explicit label,
8166 to indicate the beginning of the text section, define this macro to zero.
8167
8168 @findex DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
8169 @item DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
8170 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
8171 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
8172 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
8173
8174 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA
8175 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
8176 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
8177 between the two given labels, using an integer of the given size.
8178
8179 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET
8180 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
8181 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
8182 section-relative reference to the given label, using an integer of the
8183 given size.
8184
8185 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL
8186 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
8187 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
8188 reference to the given label, using an integer of the given size.
8189
8190 @findex PUT_SDB_@dots{}
8191 @item PUT_SDB_@dots{}
8192 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
8193 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
8194 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
8195 not define them yourself.
8196
8197 @findex SDB_DELIM
8198 @item SDB_DELIM
8199 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
8200 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
8201 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
8202 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
8203 required.
8204
8205 @findex SDB_GENERATE_FAKE
8206 @item SDB_GENERATE_FAKE
8207 Define this macro to override the usual method of constructing a dummy
8208 name for anonymous structure and union types. See @file{sdbout.c} for
8209 more information.
8210
8211 @findex SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
8212 @item SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
8213 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
8214 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
8215 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
8216 it.
8217
8218 @findex SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
8219 @item SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
8220 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
8221 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
8222 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
8223 @end table
8224
8225 @need 2000
8226 @node VMS Debug
8227 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
8228
8229 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8230 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
8231
8232 @table @code
8233 @findex VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
8234 @item VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
8235 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
8236 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
8237 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
8238 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
8239 behavior is controlled by @code{OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS} and
8240 @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}.
8241 @end table
8242
8243 @node Floating Point
8244 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
8245 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
8246 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
8247
8248 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
8249 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
8250 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
8251 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
8252 doing the compilation.
8253
8254 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
8255 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
8256 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
8257 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
8258 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
8259 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
8260 target floating point formats are identical.
8261
8262 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
8263 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
8264 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
8265 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
8266
8267 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
8268 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
8269 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
8270 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
8271 quantity.
8272 @end defmac
8273
8274 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
8275 Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
8276 floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
8277 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
8278 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
8279 @end deftypefn
8280
8281 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
8282 Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
8283 @end deftypefn
8284
8285 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8286 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
8287 @end deftypefn
8288
8289 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8290 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
8291 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
8292 @end deftypefn
8293
8294 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
8295 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
8296 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
8297 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
8298 defined by the C language for both.
8299 @end deftypefn
8300
8301 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8302 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
8303 @end deftypefn
8304
8305 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8306 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
8307 @end deftypefn
8308
8309 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8310 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
8311 @end deftypefn
8312
8313 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
8314 Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
8315 @var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
8316 variable).
8317
8318 The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
8319 following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
8320 @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
8321
8322 If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
8323 target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
8324 @code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
8325 @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
8326 @end deftypefn
8327
8328 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8329 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
8330 @end deftypefn
8331
8332 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8333 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
8334 @end deftypefn
8335
8336 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
8337 Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
8338 return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
8339 appropriate bit pattern to be output asa floating constant whose
8340 precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
8341 @end deftypefn
8342
8343 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8344 Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
8345 which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
8346 integral, it is truncated.
8347 @end deftypefn
8348
8349 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
8350 @findex REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT
8351 Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
8352 into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
8353 value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
8354 @end deftypefn
8355
8356 @node Mode Switching
8357 @section Mode Switching Instructions
8358 @cindex mode switching
8359 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
8360
8361 @table @code
8362 @findex OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING
8363 @item OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
8364 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
8365 switching in an optimizing compilation.
8366
8367 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
8368 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
8369 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
8370 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
8371 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
8372 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
8373 or @code{MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
8374
8375 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
8376 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
8377 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
8378 If you define this macro, you also have to define
8379 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
8380 @code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
8381 @code{NORMAL_MODE} is optional.
8382
8383 @findex NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
8384 @item NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
8385 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
8386 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
8387 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
8388 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
8389 The position of the initializer in the initializer - starting counting at
8390 zero - determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
8391 entity in question.
8392 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
8393 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
8394 switch is needed / supplied.
8395
8396 @findex MODE_NEEDED
8397 @item MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
8398 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
8399 @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
8400 return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
8401 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
8402 be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
8403
8404 @findex NORMAL_MODE
8405 @item NORMAL_MODE (@var{entity})
8406 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
8407 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
8408 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry and exit.
8409
8410 @findex MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE
8411 @item MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
8412 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
8413 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
8414 lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
8415 for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
8416 (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
8417 @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
8418
8419 @findex EMIT_MODE_SET
8420 @item EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
8421 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
8422 @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
8423 the insn(s) are to be inserted.
8424 @end table
8425
8426 @node Target Attributes
8427 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
8428 @cindex target attributes
8429 @cindex machine attributes
8430 @cindex attributes, target-specific
8431
8432 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
8433 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
8434 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
8435
8436 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
8437 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
8438 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
8439 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
8440 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
8441 take.
8442 @end deftypevr
8443
8444 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
8445 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
8446 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
8447 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
8448 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
8449 supposed always to be compatible.
8450 @end deftypefn
8451
8452 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
8453 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
8454 newly defined @var{type}.
8455 @end deftypefn
8456
8457 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
8458 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
8459 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
8460 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
8461 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
8462 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
8463 merging.
8464 @end deftypefn
8465
8466 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
8467 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
8468 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
8469 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
8470 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
8471 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
8472 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
8473 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
8474
8475 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
8476 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport} for
8477 Windows targets, you should define the macro
8478 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. This links in a function
8479 called @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined
8480 as the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. This is done
8481 in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
8482 @end deftypefn
8483
8484 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
8485 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
8486 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
8487 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
8488 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
8489 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
8490 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
8491 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
8492 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
8493 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
8494 needed.
8495 @end deftypefn
8496
8497 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (tree @var{fndecl})
8498 @cindex inlining
8499 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
8500 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
8501 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
8502 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
8503 @end deftypefn
8504
8505 @node MIPS Coprocessors
8506 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
8507 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
8508
8509 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
8510 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. gcc supports
8511 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
8512 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
8513
8514 @smallexample
8515 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
8516 unsigned int d;
8517
8518 d = cp0count + 3;
8519 @end smallexample
8520
8521 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
8522 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
8523 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
8524
8525 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
8526 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
8527 later in the function.
8528
8529 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
8530 the FPU. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
8531 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
8532
8533 There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
8534 you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
8535
8536 @table @code
8537
8538 @item ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8539 @findex ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8540 A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
8541 alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
8542 @smallexample
8543 @{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
8544 @end smallexample
8545 Default: empty.
8546
8547 @end table
8548
8549 @node Misc
8550 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
8551 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
8552
8553 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8554 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
8555
8556 @table @code
8557 @item PREDICATE_CODES
8558 @findex PREDICATE_CODES
8559 Define this if you have defined special-purpose predicates in the file
8560 @file{@var{machine}.c}. This macro is called within an initializer of an
8561 array of structures. The first field in the structure is the name of a
8562 predicate and the second field is an array of rtl codes. For each
8563 predicate, list all rtl codes that can be in expressions matched by the
8564 predicate. The list should have a trailing comma. Here is an example
8565 of two entries in the list for a typical RISC machine:
8566
8567 @smallexample
8568 #define PREDICATE_CODES \
8569 @{"gen_reg_rtx_operand", @{SUBREG, REG@}@}, \
8570 @{"reg_or_short_cint_operand", @{SUBREG, REG, CONST_INT@}@},
8571 @end smallexample
8572
8573 Defining this macro does not affect the generated code (however,
8574 incorrect definitions that omit an rtl code that may be matched by the
8575 predicate can cause the compiler to malfunction). Instead, it allows
8576 the table built by @file{genrecog} to be more compact and efficient,
8577 thus speeding up the compiler. The most important predicates to include
8578 in the list specified by this macro are those used in the most insn
8579 patterns.
8580
8581 For each predicate function named in @code{PREDICATE_CODES}, a
8582 declaration will be generated in @file{insn-codes.h}.
8583
8584 @item SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES
8585 @findex SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES
8586 Define this if you have special predicates that know special things
8587 about modes. Genrecog will warn about certain forms of
8588 @code{match_operand} without a mode; if the operand predicate is
8589 listed in @code{SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES}, the warning will be
8590 suppressed.
8591
8592 Here is an example from the IA-32 port (@code{ext_register_operand}
8593 specially checks for @code{HImode} or @code{SImode} in preparation
8594 for a byte extraction from @code{%ah} etc.).
8595
8596 @smallexample
8597 #define SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES \
8598 "ext_register_operand",
8599 @end smallexample
8600
8601 @findex CASE_VECTOR_MODE
8602 @item CASE_VECTOR_MODE
8603 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
8604 elements of a jump-table should have.
8605
8606 @findex CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE
8607 @item CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
8608 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
8609 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
8610 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
8611 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
8612 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
8613 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
8614 flags can be updated.
8615
8616 @findex CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
8617 @item CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
8618 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
8619 should contain relative addresses. If jump-tables never contain
8620 relative addresses, then you need not define this macro.
8621
8622 @findex CASE_DROPS_THROUGH
8623 @item CASE_DROPS_THROUGH
8624 Define this if control falls through a @code{case} insn when the index
8625 value is out of range. This means the specified default-label is
8626 actually ignored by the @code{case} insn proper.
8627
8628 @findex CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
8629 @item CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
8630 Define this to be the smallest number of different values for which it
8631 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
8632 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
8633 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
8634
8635 @findex CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
8636 @item CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
8637 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
8638 statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
8639 advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
8640 of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
8641 targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
8642 @code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
8643 @code{false} otherwise.
8644
8645 @findex WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
8646 @item WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
8647 Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
8648 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
8649 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
8650
8651 @findex LOAD_EXTEND_OP
8652 @item LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mode})
8653 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
8654 memory in @var{mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
8655 bits outside of @var{mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
8656 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
8657 of @var{mode} for which the
8658 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
8659 @code{NIL} for other modes.
8660
8661 This macro is not called with @var{mode} non-integral or with a width
8662 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
8663 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
8664 @code{NIL}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
8665 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
8666
8667 @findex SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
8668 @item SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
8669 Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
8670 extends.
8671
8672 @findex FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
8673 @item FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
8674 Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
8675 point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
8676 unsigned one.
8677
8678 @findex MOVE_MAX
8679 @item MOVE_MAX
8680 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
8681 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
8682
8683 @findex MAX_MOVE_MAX
8684 @item MAX_MOVE_MAX
8685 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
8686 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
8687 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
8688 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
8689 at run-time.
8690
8691 @findex SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
8692 @item SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
8693 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
8694 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
8695 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
8696 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
8697 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
8698 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
8699 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
8700 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
8701 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
8702 arguments to bit-field instructions.
8703
8704 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
8705 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
8706 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
8707
8708 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
8709 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
8710 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
8711 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
8712 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
8713
8714 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
8715
8716 @findex TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION
8717 @item TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
8718 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
8719 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
8720 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
8721 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
8722
8723 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
8724
8725 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
8726 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
8727 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
8728 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
8729 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
8730 such cases may improve things.
8731
8732 @findex STORE_FLAG_VALUE
8733 @item STORE_FLAG_VALUE
8734 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
8735 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
8736 (@samp{s@var{cond}}) when the condition is true. This description must
8737 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{s@var{cond}} patterns and all the
8738 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
8739
8740 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
8741 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
8742 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
8743 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
8744 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
8745 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
8746 @samp{s@var{cond}} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
8747 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
8748 the compiler.
8749
8750 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
8751 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
8752 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
8753 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
8754 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
8755 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
8756 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
8757 expression
8758
8759 @smallexample
8760 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
8761 @end smallexample
8762
8763 @noindent
8764 can be converted to
8765
8766 @smallexample
8767 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
8768 @end smallexample
8769
8770 @noindent
8771 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
8772 tested into the sign bit.
8773
8774 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
8775 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
8776 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
8777 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
8778 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
8779 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
8780
8781 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
8782 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
8783 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
8784 to be used:
8785
8786 @itemize @bullet
8787 @item
8788 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
8789 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
8790 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
8791 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
8792 combine the normalization with other operations.
8793
8794 @item
8795 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
8796 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
8797 other machines.
8798
8799 @item
8800 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
8801 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
8802 others.
8803
8804 @item
8805 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
8806 @end itemize
8807
8808 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
8809 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
8810 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
8811 those cases, e.g., one matching
8812
8813 @smallexample
8814 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
8815 @end smallexample
8816
8817 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
8818 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
8819 @samp{s@var{cond}} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
8820 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
8821 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
8822 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
8823 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptizer can be used to
8824 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
8825
8826 You need not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
8827 instructions.
8828
8829 @findex FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE
8830 @item FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
8831 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
8832 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
8833 Define this macro on machine that have comparison operations that return
8834 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
8835 this macro.
8836
8837 @findex CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO
8838 @findex CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO
8839 @item CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
8840 @itemx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
8841 A C expression that evaluates to true if the architecture defines a value
8842 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand. If so, @var{value}
8843 should be set to this value. If this macro is not defined, the value of
8844 @code{clz} or @code{ctz} is assumed to be undefined.
8845
8846 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
8847 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
8848 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases.
8849
8850 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
8851 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
8852 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
8853 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
8854 breaking the API.
8855
8856 @findex Pmode
8857 @item Pmode
8858 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
8859 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
8860 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
8861 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
8862 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
8863
8864 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
8865 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
8866 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
8867 to @code{Pmode}.
8868
8869 @findex FUNCTION_MODE
8870 @item FUNCTION_MODE
8871 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
8872 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most machines this
8873 should be @code{QImode}.
8874
8875 @findex INTEGRATE_THRESHOLD
8876 @item INTEGRATE_THRESHOLD (@var{decl})
8877 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions above which the
8878 function @var{decl} should not be inlined. @var{decl} is a
8879 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} node.
8880
8881 The default definition of this macro is 64 plus 8 times the number of
8882 arguments that the function accepts. Some people think a larger
8883 threshold should be used on RISC machines.
8884
8885 @findex STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
8886 @item STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
8887 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
8888 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
8889 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
8890 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
8891 strict conformance to the C Standard.
8892
8893 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
8894 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
8895 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
8896
8897 @findex NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
8898 @item NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
8899 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
8900 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
8901 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
8902 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
8903
8904 @findex HANDLE_PRAGMA
8905 @item HANDLE_PRAGMA (@var{getc}, @var{ungetc}, @var{name})
8906 This macro is no longer supported. You must use
8907 @code{REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS} instead.
8908
8909 @findex REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS
8910 @findex #pragma
8911 @findex pragma
8912 @item REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
8913 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
8914 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
8915 @code{c_register_pragma} for each pragma. The macro may also do any
8916 setup required for the pragmas.
8917
8918 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
8919 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
8920 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
8921
8922 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
8923 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
8924
8925 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
8926 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
8927 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
8928
8929 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
8930
8931 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} establishes one pragma. The
8932 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
8933 pragma of the form
8934
8935 @smallexample
8936 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
8937 @end smallexample
8938
8939 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
8940 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
8941 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
8942 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
8943 @var{name} by calling @code{c_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
8944 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
8945 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}.
8946
8947 For an example use of this routine, see @file{c4x.h} and the callback
8948 routines defined in @file{c4x-c.c}.
8949
8950 Note that the use of @code{c_lex} is specific to the C and C++
8951 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
8952 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{c_lex} is going
8953 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
8954 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
8955 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
8956 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
8957 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
8958 code that uses @code{c_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
8959 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
8960 how to build this object file.
8961 @end deftypefun
8962
8963 @findex HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
8964 @findex #pragma
8965 @findex pragma
8966 @item HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
8967 Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want the System V style
8968 pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(<n>)} and @samp{#pragma weak <name>
8969 [=<value>]} to be supported by gcc.
8970
8971 The pack pragma specifies the maximum alignment (in bytes) of fields
8972 within a structure, in much the same way as the @samp{__aligned__} and
8973 @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A pack value of zero resets
8974 the behavior to the default.
8975
8976 A subtlety for Microsoft Visual C/C++ style bit-field packing
8977 (e.g. -mms-bitfields) for targets that support it:
8978 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
8979 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
8980 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
8981 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
8982 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
8983 size is allocated).
8984
8985 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
8986 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
8987 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
8988 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
8989 may affect its placement.
8990
8991 The weak pragma only works if @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK} and
8992 @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} are defined. If enabled it allows the creation
8993 of specifically named weak labels, optionally with a value.
8994
8995 @findex HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
8996 @findex #pragma
8997 @findex pragma
8998 @item HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
8999 Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want to support the Win32
9000 style pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(push,@var{n})} and @samp{#pragma
9001 pack(pop)}. The @samp{pack(push,@var{n})} pragma specifies the maximum alignment
9002 (in bytes) of fields within a structure, in much the same way as the
9003 @samp{__aligned__} and @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A
9004 pack value of zero resets the behavior to the default. Successive
9005 invocations of this pragma cause the previous values to be stacked, so
9006 that invocations of @samp{#pragma pack(pop)} will return to the previous
9007 value.
9008
9009 @findex DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
9010 @item DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
9011 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in identifier
9012 names. 0 means @samp{$} is not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed.
9013 1 is the default; there is no need to define this macro in that case.
9014 This macro controls the compiler proper; it does not affect the preprocessor.
9015
9016 @findex NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
9017 @item NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
9018 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
9019 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
9020 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
9021 @samp{.} is used instead.
9022
9023 @findex NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
9024 @item NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
9025 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
9026 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
9027 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
9028 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
9029
9030 @findex DEFAULT_MAIN_RETURN
9031 @item DEFAULT_MAIN_RETURN
9032 Define this macro if the target system expects every program's @code{main}
9033 function to return a standard ``success'' value by default (if no other
9034 value is explicitly returned).
9035
9036 The definition should be a C statement (sans semicolon) to generate the
9037 appropriate rtl instructions. It is used only when compiling the end of
9038 @code{main}.
9039
9040 @item NEED_ATEXIT
9041 @findex NEED_ATEXIT
9042 Define this if the target system lacks the function @code{atexit}
9043 from the ISO C standard. If this macro is defined, a default definition
9044 will be provided to support C++. If @code{ON_EXIT} is not defined,
9045 a default @code{exit} function will also be provided.
9046
9047 @item ON_EXIT
9048 @findex ON_EXIT
9049 Define this macro if the target has another way to implement atexit
9050 functionality without replacing @code{exit}. For instance, SunOS 4 has
9051 a similar @code{on_exit} library function.
9052
9053 The definition should be a functional macro which can be used just like
9054 the @code{atexit} function.
9055
9056 @item EXIT_BODY
9057 @findex EXIT_BODY
9058 Define this if your @code{exit} function needs to do something
9059 besides calling an external function @code{_cleanup} before
9060 terminating with @code{_exit}. The @code{EXIT_BODY} macro is
9061 only needed if @code{NEED_ATEXIT} is defined and @code{ON_EXIT} is not
9062 defined.
9063
9064 @findex INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED
9065 @item INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
9066 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
9067 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
9068 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
9069 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
9070 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
9071 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
9072 you should define this macro.
9073
9074 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
9075
9076 @findex INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED
9077 @item INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
9078 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
9079 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
9080 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
9081 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
9082 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
9083 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
9084 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
9085 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
9086 slot of @var{insn}.
9087
9088 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
9089
9090 @findex MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
9091 @item MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (@var{insn})
9092 In rare cases, correct code generation requires extra machine
9093 dependent processing between the second jump optimization pass and
9094 delayed branch scheduling. On those machines, define this macro as a C
9095 statement to act on the code starting at @var{insn}.
9096
9097 @findex MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
9098 @item MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
9099 Define this macro if in some cases global symbols from one translation
9100 unit may not be bound to undefined symbols in another translation unit
9101 without user intervention. For instance, under Microsoft Windows
9102 symbols must be explicitly imported from shared libraries (DLLs).
9103
9104 @findex MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
9105 @item MD_ASM_CLOBBERS (@var{clobbers})
9106 A C statement that adds to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
9107 any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for all asms.
9108
9109 @findex MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE
9110 @item MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE
9111 Define this to the largest integer machine mode which can be used for
9112 operations other than load, store and copy operations.
9113
9114 You need only define this macro if the target holds values larger than
9115 @code{word_mode} in general purpose registers. Most targets should not define
9116 this macro.
9117
9118 @findex MATH_LIBRARY
9119 @item MATH_LIBRARY
9120 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
9121 in the system math library, or @samp{""} if the target does not have a
9122 separate math library.
9123
9124 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"-lm"} is wrong.
9125
9126 @findex LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
9127 @item LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
9128 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
9129 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
9130
9131 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
9132 is wrong.
9133
9134 @findex TARGET_HAS_F_SETLKW
9135 @item TARGET_HAS_F_SETLKW
9136 Define this macro if the target supports file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
9137 Note that this functionality is part of POSIX@.
9138 Defining @code{TARGET_HAS_F_SETLKW} will enable the test coverage code
9139 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
9140 if the program has forked.
9141
9142 @findex MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
9143 @item MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
9144
9145 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
9146 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
9147 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
9148 1 if it does use cc0.
9149
9150 @findex IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS
9151 @item IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS(@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
9152 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
9153 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
9154 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
9155 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
9156 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
9157 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
9158 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
9159
9160 @findex IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS
9161 @item IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS(@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
9162 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
9163 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
9164 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
9165 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
9166
9167 @findex IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN
9168 @item IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN(@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
9169 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
9170 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
9171 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
9172 about the currently processed blocks.
9173
9174 @findex IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL
9175 @item IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL(@var{ce_info})
9176 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
9177 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
9178 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
9179 to by @var{ce_info}.
9180
9181 @findex IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL
9182 @item IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL(@var{ce_info})
9183 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
9184 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
9185 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
9186 to by @var{ce_info}.
9187
9188 @findex IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS
9189 @item IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS(@var{ce_info})
9190 A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
9191 structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
9192
9193 @findex IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
9194 @item IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
9195 If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
9196 added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
9197 by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
9198
9199 @end table
9200
9201 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS ()
9202 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
9203 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
9204 necessary setup.
9205
9206 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
9207 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
9208 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
9209 instructions or prefetch instructions).
9210
9211 To create a built-in function, call the function @code{builtin_function}
9212 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
9213 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
9214 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
9215 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
9216 @end deftypefn
9217
9218 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
9219
9220 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
9221 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
9222 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
9223 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
9224 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
9225 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
9226 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
9227 built-in function.
9228 @end deftypefn
9229
9230 @table @code
9231 @findex MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH
9232 @item MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH(@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
9233
9234 Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
9235 Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
9236 @var{branch2} is possible.
9237
9238 On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
9239 filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
9240 may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
9241
9242 @findex ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
9243 @item ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE(@var{hard_reg})
9244
9245 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
9246 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
9247 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
9248 it has been saved into can be used. @code{ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}, if
9249 defined, is called at the start of register allocation once for each
9250 hard register that had its initial value copied by using
9251 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
9252 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
9253 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
9254 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
9255 @code{MEM}.
9256 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
9257 it might decide to use another register anyways.
9258 You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the definition of the
9259 macro, functions that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
9260 register in question will not be clobbered.
9261
9262 @findex TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
9263 @item TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
9264 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
9265 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
9266 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
9267
9268 @findex TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
9269 @item TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
9270 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
9271 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
9272 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
9273 executable files.
9274
9275 @findex COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
9276 @item COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
9277 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
9278 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
9279 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
9280 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
9281 lists.
9282
9283 @findex MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL
9284 @item MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
9285 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
9286 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
9287 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
9288 For example, on 32-bit Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
9289 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
9290 defined as this expression:
9291
9292 @smallexample
9293 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
9294 build_tree_list
9295 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
9296 NULL))
9297 @end smallexample
9298
9299 @end table
9300
9301 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
9302 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
9303 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
9304 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
9305 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
9306
9307 @smallexample
9308 static bool
9309 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
9310 @{
9311 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
9312 @}
9313 @end smallexample
9314 @end deftypefn